blob: f597a8c6057bb117124d3803911110998bc382e1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud83f6e62021-11-14 16:04:57 +01007 2021/11/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600616quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600695that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600700Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
701if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
702or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
703
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
706 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
707
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100708When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
709double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
712a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
713the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
714regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
715around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
716more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200717
718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007192.3. Environment variables
720--------------------------
721
722HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
723interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
724configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
725optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
726shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200727underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
728list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
729arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100730before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
731use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
732next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
733existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200734
735 Example:
736
737 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
738
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100739 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
744file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200745
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200746* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
747 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
748
749* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
750 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
751 directory.
752
753* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
754
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500755* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200756 processes, separated by semicolons.
757
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500758* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759 CLI, separated by semicolons.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200817Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
818See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
819
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200820The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
821expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100823 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
824 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200826 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530827 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
828 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200829 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
830 from left to right until one returns false
831 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
832 from right to left until one returns true
833
834Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
835operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836
837The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
838
839 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
840 exists, regardless of its contents
841
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200842 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
843 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
844 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
845
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200846 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
847 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
848
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200849 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
850 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
851 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
852 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
853
854 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
855 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
856 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
857 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
858
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200859Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100860
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200861 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
862 listen mwcli_px
863 bind :1111
864 ...
865 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200867 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
868 bind :80
869 .endif
870
871 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200872 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200873 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200874 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200877 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200878 bind :443 ssl crt ...
879 .endif
880
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200881 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
882 profiling.memory on
883 .endif
884
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200885 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
886 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
887 .endif
888
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200889Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100892 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
893 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
894 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
895
896Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
897"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
898fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
899provide advice to the user.
900
901Example:
902
903 .if "${A}"
904 .if "${B}"
905 .notice "A=1, B=1"
906 .elif "${C}"
907 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
908 .elif "${D}"
909 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
910 .else
911 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
912 .endif
913 .else
914 .notice "A=0"
915 .endif
916
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200917 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
918 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
919
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100920
9212.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922----------------
923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100924Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100925values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
926otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
927numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
928for every keyword. Supported units are :
929
930 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
931 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
932 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
933 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
934 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
935 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
936
937
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009382.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200939-------------
940
941 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
942 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
943 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
944 global
945 daemon
946 maxconn 256
947
948 defaults
949 mode http
950 timeout connect 5000ms
951 timeout client 50000ms
952 timeout server 50000ms
953
954 frontend http-in
955 bind *:80
956 default_backend servers
957
958 backend servers
959 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
960
961
962 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
963 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 listen http-in
975 bind *:80
976 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
977
978
979Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
980
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100981 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200982
983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985--------------------
986
987Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
988are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
989of them have command-line equivalents.
990
991The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
992
993 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200994 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001008 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001010 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001011 - h1-case-adjust
1012 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001013 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001014 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001015 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001016 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001017 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001020 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001021 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001022 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001023 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001024 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001025 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001027 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001029 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030 - presetenv
1031 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - uid
1033 - ulimit-n
1034 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001035 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001036 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001038 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001040 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001041 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-bind-options
1043 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001044 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-server-options
1046 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001047 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001048 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001049 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001051 - 51degrees-data-file
1052 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001053 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001054 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-data-file
1056 - wurfl-information-list
1057 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001058 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001059 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001062 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001063 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001065 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001066 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001067 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001068 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001069 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001070 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001071 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - noepoll
1074 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001075 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001077 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001078 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001079 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001080 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001081 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001082 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001083 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001084 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001085 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001086 - tune.buffers.limit
1087 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001088 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001089 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001090 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001091 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001092 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001093 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001094 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001095 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001096 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001097 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001098 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001099 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001100 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001103 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001104 - tune.maxaccept
1105 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001106 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001107 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001108 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001109 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1110 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001111 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1112 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001113 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001114 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001115 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001116 - tune.sndbuf.client
1117 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001118 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001119 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001120 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001121 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001123 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001125 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1126 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001128 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001129 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1130 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1131 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001132 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1133 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001137 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
1139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011403.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141------------------------------------
1142
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001143ca-base <dir>
1144 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001145 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1146 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1147 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149chroot <jail dir>
1150 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1151 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1152 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1153 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1154 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001155 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001156
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001157cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001158 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001159 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1160 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1161 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1162 set. These sets have the format
1163
1164 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1165
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001166 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1167 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001168 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001169 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001170 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1171 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001172 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1173 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1174 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1175 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1176 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1177 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1178 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1179 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1180 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1181 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001182
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001183 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1184 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1185 on the machine's word size.
1186
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001187 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1189 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1190 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1191 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1192 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1193 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001194
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001195 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1196 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1197 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1198 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1202 # first 4 CPUs
1203
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001204 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1205 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001206 # word size.
1207
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1209 # and so on.
1210 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1211 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1212 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1213
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001214 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1215 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1216 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1217 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001218
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001219 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1221 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001222
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001223crt-base <dir>
1224 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001225 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1226 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228daemon
1229 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1230 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001231 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1232 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001234default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001235 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001236 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1237 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1238 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1239 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1240 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1241 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1242 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1243 not start with a slash ('/'):
1244 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1245 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1246
1247 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1248 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1249 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1250 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1251 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1252 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1253 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1254 each of them.
1255
1256 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1257 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1258 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1259 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1260 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1261 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1262 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1263 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1264
1265 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1266 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001267 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001268 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1269 made easily relocatable.
1270
1271 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1272 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1273 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1274 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1275 consistent across all configuration files.
1276
1277 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1278 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1279 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1280 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1281 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1282 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1283 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1284 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1285
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001286deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1287 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001288 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001289
1290deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001291 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001292 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1293
1294deviceatlas-separator <char>
1295 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1296 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1297
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001298deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001299 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1300 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1301 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001302
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001303expose-experimental-directives
1304 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1305 the config file will be rejected.
1306
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001307external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001308 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1309 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001310 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1311 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1312 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1313 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1314 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001317 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001318 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1319 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001320 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001321 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001323
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001324grace <time>
1325 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1326
1327 Arguments :
1328 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1329 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1330 soft-stop operation.
1331
1332 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1333 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1334 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1335 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1336 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1337 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1338 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1339 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1340 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1341
1342 Example:
1343
1344 global
1345 grace 10s
1346
1347 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1348 frontend ext-check
1349 bind :9999
1350 monitor-uri /ext-check
1351 monitor fail if { stopping }
1352
1353 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1354 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1355 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1356 SIGUSR1 signal.
1357
1358 Example:
1359
1360 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1361 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1362 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1363 frontend ext-check
1364 bind :9999
1365 monitor-uri /ext-check
1366 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1367
1368 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1369
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001370group <group name>
1371 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1372 See also "gid" and "user".
1373
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001374hard-stop-after <time>
1375 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1376
1377 Arguments :
1378 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1379 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1380 SIGUSR1 signal.
1381
1382 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1383 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1384 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1385
1386 Example:
1387 global
1388 hard-stop-after 30s
1389
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001390 See also: grace
1391
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001392h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1393 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1394 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1395 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1396 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001397 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001398 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1399 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1400 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1401 specified in a proxy.
1402
1403 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1404 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1405 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1406 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1407 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1408 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1409 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1410
1411 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1412 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1413 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1414 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1415 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1416
1417 Example:
1418 global
1419 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1420
1421 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1422 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1423
1424h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1425 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1426 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1427 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1428 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1429 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1430 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1431 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1432 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1433
1434 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1435 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1436 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1437
1438 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1439 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1440
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001441insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001442 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001443 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1444 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1445 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1446 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1447 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1448 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1449 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001451 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1452 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1453 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1454 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1455 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1456 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1457 disable it.
1458
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001459insecure-setuid-wanted
1460 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1461 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1462 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1463 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001464 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001465 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001466 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001467 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1468 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001469 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001470 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1471 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1472 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1473 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1474
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001475issuers-chain-path <dir>
1476 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1477 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1478 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001479 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001480 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1481 "issuers-chain-path".
1482 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1483 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1484 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1485 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1486 will share the chain in memory.
1487
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001488h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1489 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1490 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1491 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1492 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1493 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1494 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1495 the keyword with "no'.
1496
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001497localpeer <name>
1498 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1499 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1500 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1501 the configuration parsing.
1502
1503 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1504 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1505
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001506log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001507 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001508 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001509 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001510 configured with "log global".
1511
1512 <address> can be one of:
1513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001514 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1516 port).
1517
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001518 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1519 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1520 port).
1521
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001522 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001523 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1524 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001526
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001527 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1528 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1529 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1530 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1531 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1532 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1533 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1534 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1535 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1536 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001537 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001538 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1539 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1540 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001541 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1542 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001543
1544 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1545 "fd@2", see above.
1546
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001547 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1548 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1549 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1550 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1551 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1552
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001553 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1554 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001555
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001556 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1557 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1558 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1559 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1560 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1561 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1562 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1563 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1564 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1565 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001566 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1567 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001568
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001569 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1570 one of the following :
1571
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001572 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1573 field is stripped. This is the default.
1574 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1575 rfc3164.
1576
1577 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1579
1580 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1582
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001583 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1584 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1585 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1586 designed to be used with a local log server.
1587
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001588 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1589 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1590 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1591 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1592 logger consumes.
1593
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001594 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1595 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1596 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1597 used with a local log server.
1598
1599 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1600 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1601 designed to be used with a local log server.
1602
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001603 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1604 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1605 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1606 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1607
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001608 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1609 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1610 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1611 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1612 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1613
1614 <sample_size>
1615 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1616 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1617 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1618 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1619 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1620
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001621 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001622
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001623 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1624 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1625 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1626
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001627 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1628 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1629 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1630 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631
1632 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001633 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1634 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1635 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1636 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1637 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1638 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001640 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001642log-send-hostname [<string>]
1643 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1644 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1645 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1646 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1647 the logs.
1648
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001649log-tag <string>
1650 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1651 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1652 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001653 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001654
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001655lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001656 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1657 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1658 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1659 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1660 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1661 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001662 used multiple times.
1663
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001664lua-load-per-thread <file>
1665 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1666 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1667 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1668 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1669 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1670 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1671 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1672 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1673 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1674 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1675 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1676 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1677 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1678 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1679 times.
1680
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001681lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1682 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1683 variable.
1684 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1685 to "path".
1686
1687 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1688 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1689 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1690 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1691 will be checked earlier.
1692
1693 As an example by specifying the following path:
1694
1695 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1696 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1697
1698 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1699 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1700 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1701 paths if that does not exist either.
1702
1703 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1704 documentation.
1705
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001706master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001707 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1708 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1709 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001710 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001711 or daemon mode.
1712
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001713 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1714 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1715 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1716 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1717 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001719 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001720
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001721mworker-max-reloads <number>
1722 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001723 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001724 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1725 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1726 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1727
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001728nbthread <number>
1729 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001730 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1731 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1732 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1733 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1734 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1735 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1736 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001737
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001738numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001739 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001740 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1741 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1742 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1743 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1744 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1745 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1746 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1747 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1748
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001749pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001750 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1751 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1752 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1753 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001754
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001755pp2-never-send-local
1756 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1757 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1758 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1759 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1760 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1761 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1762 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1763 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1764 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1765 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1766 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1767
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001768presetenv <name> <value>
1769 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1770 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1771 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1772 and "unsetenv".
1773
1774resetenv [<name> ...]
1775 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1776 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1777 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1778 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1779 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1780 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1781 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1782 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1783
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001784stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001785 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1786 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1787 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001788
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001789server-state-base <directory>
1790 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001791 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1792 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001793
1794server-state-file <file>
1795 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1796 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1797 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1798 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1799 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1800 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1801 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1802 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001803 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1804 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001805
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001806set-var <var-name> <expr>
1807 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1808 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1809 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1810 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1811 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1812 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001813 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001814 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1815 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1816
1817 Example:
1818 global
1819 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1820 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1821 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1822
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001823set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1824 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1825 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1826 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1827 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1828 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1829 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1830 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1831 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1832 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1833 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
1837 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1838 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1839
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001840setenv <name> <value>
1841 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1842 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1843 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1844 and "unsetenv".
1845
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001846set-dumpable
1847 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001848 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1849 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1850 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1851 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1852 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1853 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1854 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1855 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1856 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1857 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1858 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1859 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1860 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1861 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1862 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001863 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001864 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001866ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1868 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001869 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001870 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001871 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1872 information and recommendations see e.g.
1873 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1874 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1875 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1876 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001877
1878ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1880 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1881 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1882 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1883 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001884 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1885 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1886 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001887 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001888
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001889ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1891 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1892 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1893 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1894 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1895
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001896ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1898 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1899 keyword to see available options.
1900
1901 Example:
1902 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001903 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001904
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001905ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1907 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001908 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001909 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001910 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1911 information and recommendations see e.g.
1912 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1913 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1914 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1915 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1916 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001917
1918ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1920 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1921 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1922 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1923 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001924 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1925 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1926 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1927 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001928
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001929ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1931 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1932 keyword to see available options.
1933
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001934ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1936 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1937 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001939 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001940 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1941 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1942 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1943 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001944 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1945 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1946 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1947
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001948ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1949 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1950 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001951 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001952 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001953 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1954
1955 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001956
1957 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1958 and won't try to remove them.
1959
1960 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1961
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001962ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001964 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1965 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1966 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967
1968 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1969 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1970 optimize the startup time.
1971
1972 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1973 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1974 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1975
1976 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001977 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001978
1979 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001980 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1981 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001982
1983 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1984 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1985 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1986 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1987 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001988 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001989
1990 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001991 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001992 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1993 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1994 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1995 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1996 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001997 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001998
1999 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2000
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002002 a cert bundle.
2003
2004 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2005 separately in several "crt".
2006
2007 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2008 since files are loading separately.
2009
2010 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2011 required to commit them.
2012
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002013 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002014 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002015
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002016 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2017 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2018 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002019
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002020 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2021 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2022 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002023
2024 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002025 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2026 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002027
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002028 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2029 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2030
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002031 The default behavior is "all".
2032
2033 Example:
2034 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2035 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2036 ssl-load-extra-files none
2037
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002038 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2039 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002040
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002041ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2042 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2043 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2044 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2045
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002046ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002047 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002048 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2049 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2050 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2051 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2052 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2053 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002054 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002055
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002056stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2057 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2058 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2059 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002060 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002061 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002062
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002063 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2064 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2065 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002066
2067stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2068 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2069 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002070 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002071
2072stats maxconn <connections>
2073 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2074 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2075
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002076thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2077 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2078 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2079 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2080 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2081 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2082 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2083 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2084 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2085 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2086
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002087thread-groups <number>
2088 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2089 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2090 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2091
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002092uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002093 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002094 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2095 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2096 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2097
2098ulimit-n <number>
2099 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2100 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2101 option.
2102
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002103 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2104 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2105 manually specify this value.
2106
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002107unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2108 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2109
2110 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2111 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2112 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2113 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2114 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002115 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002116 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2117 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2118 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2119 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002121unsetenv [<name> ...]
2122 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2123 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2124 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2125 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2126 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2127 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2128 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130user <user name>
2131 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2132 See also "uid" and "group".
2133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002134node <name>
2135 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2136
2137 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2138 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2139 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2140 traffic.
2141
2142description <text>
2143 Add a text that describes the instance.
2144
2145 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2146 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2147 "<" and ">" characters.
2148
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100214951degrees-data-file <file path>
2150 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002151 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2155
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000215651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002157 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2158 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2159 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002162 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2163
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200216451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002165 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2166 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2170
217151degrees-cache-size <number>
2172 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2173 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2174 By default, this cache is disabled.
2175
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002176 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002177 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2178
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002179wurfl-data-file <file path>
2180 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2181 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2182
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002183 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002184 with USE_WURFL=1.
2185
2186wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2187 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2188 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2189 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2190
2191 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2192
2193 Valid WURFL properties are:
2194 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2195
2196 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2197 device.
2198
2199 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2200 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2201
2202 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2203 particular web request.
2204
2205 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2206 used Libwurfl API version.
2207
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002208 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2209 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2210
2211 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2212 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2213
2214 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2215
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002216 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002217 with USE_WURFL=1.
2218
2219wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2220 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2221 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2222
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002223 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002224 with USE_WURFL=1.
2225
2226wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2227 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2228 thus before the chroot.
2229
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002230 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002231 with USE_WURFL=1.
2232
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002233wurfl-cache-size <size>
2234 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2235 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002236 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002237 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002238
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002239 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002240 with USE_WURFL=1.
2241
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002242strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002243 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002244 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2245 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002246 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002247 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250-----------------------
2251
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002252busy-polling
2253 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2254 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2255 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2256 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2257 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2258 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2259 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2260 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2261 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2262 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2263 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2264 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2265 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2266 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2267 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2268 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2269 "poll" pollers.
2270
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002271 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2272 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2273 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2274
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002275max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002276 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002277 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2278 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2279 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2280 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2281 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2282 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2283 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002285maxconn <number>
2286 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2287 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2288 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002289 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2290 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2291 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2292 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002293 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2294 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2295 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2296 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2297 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2298 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002300maxconnrate <number>
2301 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2302 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2303 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2304 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2305 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2306 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2307 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2308 fairness.
2309
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002310maxcomprate <number>
2311 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002312 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002313 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2314 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2315 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002316 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002317 default value.
2318
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002319maxcompcpuusage <number>
2320 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2321 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2322 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002323 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2324 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2325 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2326 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002327
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002328maxpipes <number>
2329 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2330 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2331 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2332 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2333 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2334 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2335
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002336maxsessrate <number>
2337 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2338 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2339 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2340 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2341 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2342 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2343 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2344 fairness.
2345
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002346maxsslconn <number>
2347 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2348 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2349 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2350 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2351 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2352 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2353 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002354 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2355 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2356 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2357 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002358 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002359 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2360 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002361
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002362maxsslrate <number>
2363 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2364 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2365 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2366 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2367 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2368 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2369 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2370 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2371 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2372 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2373
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002374maxzlibmem <number>
2375 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2376 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2377 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002378 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2379 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2380 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002382noepoll
2383 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2384 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002385 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002386
2387nokqueue
2388 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2389 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2390 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2391
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002392noevports
2393 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2394 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2395 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2396 also "nopoll".
2397
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002398nopoll
2399 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2400 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002402 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2403 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002404
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002405nosplice
2406 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002407 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002408 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002409 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002410 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2411 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2412 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2413 "option splice-response".
2414
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002415nogetaddrinfo
2416 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2417 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2418
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002419noreuseport
2420 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2421 command line argument "-dR".
2422
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002423profiling.memory { on | off }
2424 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2425 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2426 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2427 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2428 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2429 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2430 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2431 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2432 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2433
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002434profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2435 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2436 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2437 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2438 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002439 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002440 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2441 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2442 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2443 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2444
2445 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2446 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2447 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2448 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2449 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002450 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2451 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2452 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2453 CLI.
2454
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002455spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002456 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2457 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2458 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2459 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2460 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2461 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002462
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002463ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002464 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002465 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002466 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002467 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002468 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2469 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2470 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002471 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2472 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002473 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2474 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2475 openssl configuration file uses:
2476 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2477
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002478ssl-mode-async
2479 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002480 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002481 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2482 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002484 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002485 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002486
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002487tune.buffers.limit <number>
2488 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2489 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2490 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2491 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2492 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002493 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002494 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2495 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2496 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2497 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2498 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2499 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2500 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2501 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002502 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002503
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002504tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2505 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2506 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2507 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002508 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002509
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002510tune.bufsize <number>
2511 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2512 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2513 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2514 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2515 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2516 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2517 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002518 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2519 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002521 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002522 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002523 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2524 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002525
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002526tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2527 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2528 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2529 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2530 this value. The default value is 1.
2531
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002532tune.fail-alloc
2533 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2534 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2535 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2536 gracefully.
2537
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002538tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2539 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2540 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2541 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2542 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2543 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2544
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002545tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2546 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2547 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2548 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2549 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2550 change it.
2551
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002552tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2553 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002554 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002555 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002556 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2557 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2558 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2559 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2560 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2561
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002562tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2563 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2564 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2565 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2566 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2567 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002568 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002569 recommended not to change this value.
2570
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002571tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002572 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002573 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002574 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002575 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2576 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2577 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2578 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2579
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002580tune.http.cookielen <number>
2581 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2582 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2583 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2584 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2585 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2586 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2587 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2588 to change this value.
2589
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002590tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2592 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002593 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002594 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002595 configuration directives too.
2596 The default value is 1024.
2597
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002598tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2599 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2600 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2601 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2602 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2603 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2604 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002605 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2606 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2607 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002608
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002609tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2610 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2611 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2612 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2613 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2614 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2615 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002616 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2617 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2618 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2619 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2620 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002621
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002622tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002623 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002624 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2625 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2626 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2627 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002628 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002630 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002631 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2632
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002633tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2634 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2635 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2636 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2637 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2638 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2639 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2640 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2641 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2642 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2643
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002644tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2645 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002646 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002647 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2648 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002649 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002650 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2651 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2652
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002653tune.lua.maxmem
2654 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2655 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2656 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2657 memory.
2658
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002659tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2660 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002661 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2662 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002663 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002664
2665tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2666 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2667 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2668 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2669 check servers.
2670
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002671tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2672 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2673 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2674 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002675 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002676
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002677tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002678 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2679 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002680 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2681 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2682 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2683 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2684 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2685 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2686 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2687 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2688 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002689
2690tune.maxpollevents <number>
2691 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2692 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2693 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2694 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2695 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2696
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002697tune.maxrewrite <number>
2698 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2699 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2700 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2701 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2702 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2703 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2704 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2705 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2706 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2707 bufsize.
2708
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002709tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2710 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2711 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2712 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2713 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2714 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2715 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2716 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2717 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2718 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002719 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2720 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002721 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2722 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2723 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2724 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2725 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2726 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2727 setting this parameter to 0.
2728
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002729tune.pipesize <number>
2730 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2731 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2732 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2733 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2734 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2735 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2736
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002737tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2738 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002739 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002740 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2741 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2742 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2743 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002744 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002745
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002746tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2747 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002748 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002749 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2750 default is 20.
2751
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002752tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2753tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2754 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2755 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2756 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002757 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002758 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002759 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2760 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2761
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002762tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002763 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002764 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2765 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2766 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2767 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2768
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002769tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002770 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002771 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2772 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2773 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2774 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2775 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2776 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2777 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002778
2779tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2780 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002781 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002782 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2783 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2784 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2785 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2786 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2787 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2788 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002789
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002790tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2791tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2792 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2793 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2794 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002795 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002796 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002797 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2798 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2799 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2800 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002801 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002802
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002803tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002804 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002805 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2806 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2807 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2808 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2809 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2810 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2811 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2812 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2813 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002814 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2815 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002816
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002817tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002818 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002819 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2820 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2821 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2822 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2823 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2824
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002825tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2826 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2827 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2828 performances. This is disabled by default.
2829
2830 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2831 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2832
2833 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2834
2835 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2836
2837 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2838
2839 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2840 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2841 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2842
2843 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2844 converted.
2845
2846 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2847 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2848 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2849 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2850 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2851 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2852 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002853 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2854 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002855
2856 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2857
2858 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2859 only need this line:
2860
2861 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2862
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002863tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2864 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002865 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002866 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2867 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2868 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2869 being used for too long.
2870
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002871tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2872 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2873 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2874 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2875 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2876 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2877 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2878 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2879 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2880 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2881 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002882 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002883 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002884
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002885tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2886 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2887 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2888 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2889 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002890 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002891 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2892 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002893 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2894 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002895
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002896tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2897 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2898 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2899 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2900 1000 entries.
2901
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002902tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2903tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002904 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2905 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2906 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2907 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002908
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002909tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002910tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002911tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2912tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2913tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002914 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2915 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2916 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2917 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2918 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2919 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2920 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2921 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002922
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002923 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2924 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2925 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2926 all available space is consumed.
2927 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2928 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2929 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002930
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002931tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2932 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002933 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002934 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002935 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002936 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2937
2938tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2939 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2940 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2942 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029443.3. Debugging
2945--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002946
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002947quiet
2948 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2949 line argument "-q".
2950
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002951zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002952 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002953 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2954 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2955 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2956 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2957 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2958
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029603.4. Userlists
2961--------------
2962It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2963http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2964it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2965
2966userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002967 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002968 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2969
2970group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002971 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002972 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2973 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002975user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2976 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002977 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2978 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002979 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2980 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2981 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2982 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002983
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002984 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2985 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2986 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2987 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2988 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2989 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2990 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002991 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002992 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002993
2994 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002995 userlist L1
2996 group G1 users tiger,scott
2997 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002998
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002999 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3000 user scott insecure-password elgato
3001 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003002
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003003 userlist L2
3004 group G1
3005 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003006
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003007 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3008 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3009 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003010
3011 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003012
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003013
30143.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003015----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003016It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003017several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003018instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003019values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3020type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3021values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3022active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3023switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3024present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3025watch it.
3026
3027Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3028known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3029the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3030process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3031during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3032tables.
3033
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003034Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3035that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3036each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003037
3038peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003039 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003040 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3041
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3043 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3044 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3045
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003046disabled
3047 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3048 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3049 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3050
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003051default-bind [param*]
3052 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3053
3054default-server [param*]
3055 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3056
3057 Arguments:
3058 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3059 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3060 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3061 details.
3062
3063
3064 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3065
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003066enabled
3067 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3068 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003069
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003070log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003071 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3072 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3073 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3074 more details.
3075
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3078 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003079 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003080 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003081 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3082 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3083 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003084
3085 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3086 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3087
3088 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003089 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3090 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3091 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003092
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003093 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3094 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003095
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003096 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3097 "server" keyword explanation below).
3098
3099server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003100 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003101 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3102 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3103 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3104 of this "peers" section).
3105 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3106
3107
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003108 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003109 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003110 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003111 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3112 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3113 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003114
3115 backend mybackend
3116 mode tcp
3117 balance roundrobin
3118 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3119 stick on src
3120
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003121 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3122 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003123
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003124 Example:
3125 peers mypeers
3126 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3127 default-server ssl verify none
3128 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3129 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003130
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003131
3132table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3133 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3134
3135 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3136 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003137 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003138 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3139 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3140 "stick-table" keyword).
3141
3142 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3143 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3144 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3145 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3146 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3147 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3148 of the stick-table name as follows:
3149
3150 peers mypeers
3151 peer A ...
3152 peer B ...
3153 table t1 ...
3154
3155 frontend fe1
3156 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3157
3158 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3159 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3160
3161 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3162 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3163 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3164 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3165 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3166 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3167 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3168
3169 peers mypeers
3170 peer A ...
3171 peer B ...
3172 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3173
3174 backend t1
3175 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3176
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003177 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003178 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3179 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3180
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031813.6. Mailers
3182------------
3183It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3184If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3185in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3186
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003187mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003188 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3189 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3190
3191mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3192 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3193
3194 Example:
3195 mailers mymailers
3196 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3197 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3198
3199 backend mybackend
3200 mode tcp
3201 balance roundrobin
3202
3203 email-alert mailers mymailers
3204 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3205 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3206
3207 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3208 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3209
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003210timeout mail <time>
3211 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3212 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3213 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3214 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3215
3216 Example:
3217 mailers mymailers
3218 timeout mail 20s
3219 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003220
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032213.7. Programs
3222-------------
3223In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3224master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3225managed the same way as the workers.
3226
3227During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3228sequence as a worker:
3229
3230 - the master is re-executed
3231 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3232 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3233 instance of the program
3234
3235During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3236
3237program <name>
3238 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3239 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3240 the management guide).
3241
3242command <command> [arguments*]
3243 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3244 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3245 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3246 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3247
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003248user <user name>
3249 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3250 See also "group".
3251
3252group <group name>
3253 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3254 See also "user".
3255
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003256option start-on-reload
3257no option start-on-reload
3258 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3259 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3260 program section.
3261
3262
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032633.8. HTTP-errors
3264----------------
3265
3266It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3267imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3268several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3269
3270http-errors <name>
3271 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3272 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3273
3274errorfile <code> <file>
3275 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3276
3277 Arguments :
3278 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003279 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003280 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003281
3282 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3283 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3284 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3285 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3286 before any chroot is performed.
3287
3288 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3289
3290 Example:
3291 http-errors website-1
3292 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3293 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3294 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3295
3296 http-errors website-2
3297 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3298 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3299 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3300
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020033013.9. Rings
3302----------
3303
3304It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3305servers or traces.
3306
3307ring <ringname>
3308 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3309
3310description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003311 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003312 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3313
3314format <format>
3315 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3316
3317 Arguments:
3318 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3319 one of the following :
3320
3321 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3322 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3323 designed to be used with a local log server.
3324
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003325 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3326 field is stripped. This is the default.
3327 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3328 rfc3164.
3329
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003330 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3331 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3332 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3333 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3334 is the default.
3335
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003336 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003337 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3338
3339 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3340 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3341
3342 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3343 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3344 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3345 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3346 logger consumes.
3347
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003348 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3349 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3350 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3351 with a local log server.
3352
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003353 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3354 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3355 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3356 used with a local log server.
3357
3358maxlen <length>
3359 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3360 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3361 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3362
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003363server <name> <address> [param*]
3364 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3365 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3366 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3367 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3368 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3369 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3370 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3371 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3372 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003373 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3374 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003375
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003376size <size>
3377 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3378 set to BUFSIZE.
3379
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003380timeout connect <timeout>
3381 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3382
3383 Arguments :
3384 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3385 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3386 as explained at the top of this document.
3387
3388timeout server <timeout>
3389 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3390
3391 Arguments :
3392 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3393 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3394 as explained at the top of this document.
3395
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003396 Example:
3397 global
3398 log ring@myring local7
3399
3400 ring myring
3401 description "My local buffer"
3402 format rfc3164
3403 maxlen 1200
3404 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003405 timeout connect 5s
3406 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003407 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003408
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020034093.10. Log forwarding
3410-------------------
3411
3412It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003413HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003414
3415log-forward <name>
3416 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3417
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003418backlog <conns>
3419 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3420 on connections accept.
3421
3422bind <addr> [param*]
3423 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003424 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3425 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3426 syslog protocol over TCP.
3427 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003428 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3429
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003430dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003431 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3432 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3433 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3434 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003435 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003436
3437log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003438log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003439 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3440 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3441 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003442 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003443 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3444 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3445 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003446 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003447
3448 Example:
3449 global
3450 log stderr format iso local7
3451
3452 ring myring
3453 description "My local buffer"
3454 format rfc5424
3455 maxlen 1200
3456 size 32764
3457 timeout connect 5s
3458 timeout server 10s
3459 # syslog tcp server
3460 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3461
3462 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003463 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3464 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003465 # all messages on stderr
3466 log global
3467 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3468 log ring@myring local0
3469 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3470 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3471 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3472 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3473 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003474
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003475maxconn <conns>
3476 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3477 10 is the default.
3478
3479timeout client <timeout>
3480 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034824. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003483----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003485Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003486 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3487 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3488 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3489 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003490
3491A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3492connections.
3493
3494A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3495to forward incoming connections.
3496
3497A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3498parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3499
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003500A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3501ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3502sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3503the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3504explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3505from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3506"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3507for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3508to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3509optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3510are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3511any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3512names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3513that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3514duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003515names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3516is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3517implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3518encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3519adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003520
3521Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3522settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3523of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3524profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3525timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3528'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3529case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3530
3531Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3532logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3533proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3534However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3535name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3536
3537Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3538and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003539bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3541modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3542arbitrary criteria.
3543
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003544In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3545a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003546the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003547
3548 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3549 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3550 between responses and new requests.
3551
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003552 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3553 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3554 client-facing connection remains open.
3555
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003556 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3557 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003558
3559The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3560frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3561following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003562weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003563
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003564 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003565
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003566 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3567 ----+-----+-----+----
3568 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3569 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003570 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3571 ----+-----+-----+----
3572 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003573
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003574It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003575only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3576within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003577as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003578content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003579and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3580possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003581
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003582There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003583first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003584processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003585second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003586protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3587is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3588new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003589to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003590process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3591already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3592HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3593evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3594one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3595
3596There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3597performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3598tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3599preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3600analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3601HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3602header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3603mitigate this drawback.
3604
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003605There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003606method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3607set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3608in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3609is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3610to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3611above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3612to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3613"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3614frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3615frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3616as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3617upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3618on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3619the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3620upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3621frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3622remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036244.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3625--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003627The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3628limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3629they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3630limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003631marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003632option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003633and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3634with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003635specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3636sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3637anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003639
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3641------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003642acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643backlog X X X -
3644balance X - X X
3645bind - X X -
3646bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003647capture cookie - X X -
3648capture request header - X X -
3649capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003650clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3651clitcpka-idle X X X -
3652clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003653compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003655declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003656default-server X - X X
3657default_backend X X X -
3658description - X X X
3659disabled X X X X
3660dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003661email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003662email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003663email-alert mailers X X X X
3664email-alert myhostname X X X X
3665email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003666enabled X X X X
3667errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003668errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669errorloc X X X X
3670errorloc302 X X X X
3671-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3672errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003673error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003674force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003675filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003677hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003678http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003679http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003680http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003681http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003682http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003683http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003684http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003685http-check set-var X - X X
3686http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003687http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003688http-request X (!) X X X
3689http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003690http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003691http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003693ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003694load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003695log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003696log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003697log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003698log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003699max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700maxconn X X X -
3701mode X X X X
3702monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003703monitor-uri X X X -
3704option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3705option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3706option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3707option allbackups (*) X - X X
3708option checkcache (*) X - X X
3709option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3710option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003711option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3713option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3715option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003716option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3717option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003718option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003719option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003720option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003721option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003722option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3724option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3725option httpchk X - X X
3726option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003727option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003728option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003729option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003730option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003731option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003732option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3733option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3734option logasap (*) X X X -
3735option mysql-check X - X X
3736option nolinger (*) X X X X
3737option originalto X X X X
3738option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003739option pgsql-check X - X X
3740option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003741option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003742option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003743option smtpchk X - X X
3744option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3745option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3746option splice-request (*) X X X X
3747option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003748option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3750option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3751-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003752option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3754option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3755option tcpka X X X X
3756option tcplog X X X X
3757option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003758external-check command X - X X
3759external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003760persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3761rate-limit sessions X X X -
3762redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003763-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003764retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003765retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003766server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003767server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003768server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003769source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003770srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3771srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3772srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003773stats admin - X X X
3774stats auth X X X X
3775stats enable X X X X
3776stats hide-version X X X X
3777stats http-request - X X X
3778stats realm X X X X
3779stats refresh X X X X
3780stats scope X X X X
3781stats show-desc X X X X
3782stats show-legends X X X X
3783stats show-node X X X X
3784stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003785-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3786stick match - - X X
3787stick on - - X X
3788stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003789stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003790stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003791tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003792tcp-check connect X - X X
3793tcp-check expect X - X X
3794tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003795tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003796tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003797tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003798tcp-check set-var X - X X
3799tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003800tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3801tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3802tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3803tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3804tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3805tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003806timeout check X - X X
3807timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003808timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003809timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003810timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3811timeout http-request X X X X
3812timeout queue X - X X
3813timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003814timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003815timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003816timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003817transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003818unique-id-format X X X -
3819unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003820use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003821use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003822use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003823------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3824 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003825
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3828---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003829
3830This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3831
3832
3833acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3834 Declare or complete an access list.
3835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003836 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3837
3838 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3839 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3840 using it.
3841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003842 Example:
3843 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3844 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3845 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003847 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848
3849
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003850backlog <conns>
3851 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | no
3854 Arguments :
3855 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3856 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003857 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003858
3859 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3860 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3861 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3862 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3863 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3864 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3865 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3866 backlog parameter.
3867
3868 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3869 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3870 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3871
3872 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3873
3874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003875balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003876balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
3880 Arguments :
3881 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3882 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3883 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3884 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3885
3886 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3887 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3888 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3889 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003890 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003891 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003892 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3893 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3894 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3895 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3896 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3897 it, so that you don't worry.
3898
3899 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3900 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3901 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3902 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3903 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3904 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3905 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3906 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003908 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3909 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3910 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3911 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3912 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3913 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3914 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003915 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3916 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3917 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003918
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003919 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003920 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003921 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3922 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003923 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003924 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3925 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3926 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3927 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3928 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003929 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3930 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3931 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3932 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3933 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3934 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003936 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3937 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3938 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3939 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3940 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3941 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3942 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3943 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003944 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003945 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003946 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3947 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3948 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003949
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003950 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3951 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3952 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3953 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3954 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3955 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3956 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3957 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3958 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3959 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3960 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3961 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003963 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003964 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3965 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3966 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3967 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3968 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3969 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3970 URIs start with a leading "/".
3971
3972 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3973 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3974 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3975 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3976
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003977 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3978 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3979 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3980 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003982 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003983 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3984
3985 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003986 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3987 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003988 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3989 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3990 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3991 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003992 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003993 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3994 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003995
3996 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3997 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3998 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3999 server will receive the request.
4000
4001 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4002 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4003 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4004 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4005 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004006 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4007 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
4008 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004010 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4011 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4012 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4013 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4014 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004016 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004017 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4018 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4019 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4020
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004021 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4022 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4023 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4024
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004025 random
4026 random(<draws>)
4027 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004028 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4029 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4030 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4031 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004032 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4033 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4034 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4035 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4036 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4037 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4038 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4039 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4040 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4041 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4042 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4043 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4044 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4045 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4046 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4047 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4048 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4049 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4050 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4051 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004052
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004053 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004054 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004055 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4056 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
4057 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
4058 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4059 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4060 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004061 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004062 used instead.
4063
4064 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4065 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4066 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
4067 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
4068
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004069 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4070 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4071 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4072
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004073 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004076 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4077 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004078
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004079 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4080 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4081 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004082
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004083 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004084 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004085 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4086 NTLM relies on.
4087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004088 Examples :
4089 balance roundrobin
4090 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004091 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004092 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4093 balance hdr(host)
4094 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004095
4096 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4097 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004099 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004100 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4101 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4102 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004103 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004104
4105 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4106 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4107 defaults to 16 kB.
4108
4109 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4110 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4111
4112 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4113 Round Robin.
4114
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004115 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004116 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4117 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4118 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4119
4120 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4121
4122 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004123 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004124 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4125 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4126 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004127
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004128 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129
4130
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004131bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4132bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 no | yes | yes | no
4136 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004137 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4138 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4139 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4140 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004141 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004142 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4143 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4144 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4145 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4146 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4147 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004148 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004149 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4150 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004151 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004152 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4153 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004154 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004155 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4156 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004157 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004158 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004159 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4160 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4161 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004162 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4163 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4164 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4165 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004166 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4167 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4168 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004169
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004170 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4171 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004172 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4173 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4174 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004175 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4176 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4177 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4178 the range.
4179
4180 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4181 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4182 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4183 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4184 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4185 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4186 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004187 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004188 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004190 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004191 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004192 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4193 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4194 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4195 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4196 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4197 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4198
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004199 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4200 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4201 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4202 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4205 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4206 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4207 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4208 in a frontend.
4209
4210 Example :
4211 listen http_proxy
4212 bind :80,:443
4213 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004214 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004216 listen http_https_proxy
4217 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004218 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004219
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004220 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4221 bind ipv6@:80
4222 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4223 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4224
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004225 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004226 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004227
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004228 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4229 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4230 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4231 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4232 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4233
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004234 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004235 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236
4237
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004238bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4240 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004241
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004242 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4243 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4244 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4245 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4246 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4247 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004248
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004249 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004250
4251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004252capture cookie <name> len <length>
4253 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 no | yes | yes | no
4256 Arguments :
4257 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4258 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4259 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4260 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004261 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004262
4263 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4264 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4265 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4266 right if it exceeds <length>.
4267
4268 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4269 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4270 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4271 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4272
4273 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4274 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4275 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4276
4277 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4278 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4279 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004280 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4281 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4282 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004283
4284 Example:
4285 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4286
4287 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004288 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289
4290
4291capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004292 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 no | yes | yes | no
4295 Arguments :
4296 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004297 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4299 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4300 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4301
4302 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4303 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4304 it exceeds <length>.
4305
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004306 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004307 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4308 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004309 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4310 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4311 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4312 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004313 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004314 environments to find where the request came from.
4315
4316 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4317 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4318 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4319 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004321 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4322 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4323 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4324 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4325 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004326
4327 Example:
4328 capture request header Host len 15
4329 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004330 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004332 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004333 about logging.
4334
4335
4336capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004337 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4339 no | yes | yes | no
4340 Arguments :
4341 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004342 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4344 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4345 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4346
4347 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4348 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4349 it exceeds <length>.
4350
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004351 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004352 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4353 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4354 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004355 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4356 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4357 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4358 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004360 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4361 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4362 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4363 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4364 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004365
4366 Example:
4367 capture response header Content-length len 9
4368 capture response header Location len 15
4369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004370 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004371 about logging.
4372
4373
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004374clitcpka-cnt <count>
4375 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4376 the connection on the client side.
4377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4378 yes | yes | yes | no
4379 Arguments :
4380 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4381
4382 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4383 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004384 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4385 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004386
4387 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4388
4389
4390clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4391 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4392 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4393 client side.
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | yes | yes | no
4396 Arguments :
4397 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4398 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4399 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4400 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4401
4402 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4403 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004404 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4405 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004406
4407 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4408
4409
4410clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4411 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4413 yes | yes | yes | no
4414 Arguments :
4415 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4416 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4417 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4418 document.
4419
4420 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4421 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004422 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4423 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004424
4425 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4426
4427
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004428compression algo <algorithm> ...
4429compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004430 Enable HTTP compression.
4431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4432 yes | yes | yes | yes
4433 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004434 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4435 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004436
4437 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004438 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4439 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4440 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004441
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004442 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004443 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004444
4445 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4446 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4447 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4448 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4449 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004450 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004452 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4453 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4454 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4455 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4456 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4457 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4458 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004459 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004460
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004461 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004462 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004463 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004464 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004468
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004469 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004470 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4471 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004472 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004473 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004474 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4475 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4476 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4477 "multipart"
4478 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4479 header
4480 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4481 and later
4482 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4483 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004484 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004485
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004486 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004487
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004488 Examples :
4489 compression algo gzip
4490 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004492 See also : "compression offload"
4493
4494compression offload
4495 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 no | yes | yes | yes
4498
4499 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4500 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4501 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4502 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4503 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4504 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4505 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4506 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4507 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4508 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4509 then be used for such scenarios.
4510
4511 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4512 option is ignored.
4513
4514 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004515
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004516cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004517 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4518 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004519 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004520 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | no | yes | yes
4523 Arguments :
4524 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4525 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4526 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4527 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4528 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4529 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004530 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4532 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4533
4534 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004535 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004536 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4537 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4538 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4539 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004540 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4541 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004542 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004543 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4544 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004545
4546 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004547 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004548
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004549 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004550 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004551 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004552 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004553 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4554 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4555 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4556 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4557 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4558 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4559 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004560
4561 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4562 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4563 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4564 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4565 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4566 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4567 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4568 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4569 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004570 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004571 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4572 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4573 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004574
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004575 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4576 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4577 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004578 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4579 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4580 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4581 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004582 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4583 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4584 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004585
4586 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4587 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4588 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4589 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4590 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4591 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4592 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4593 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4594 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4595
4596 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4597 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4598 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4599 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4600 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4601 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4602 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4603 persistence cookie in the cache.
4604 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4605
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004606 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4607 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004608 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004609 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4610 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004611 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004612 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4613 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4614 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4615 they logout.
4616
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004617 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004618 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4619 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4620 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4621
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004622 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004623 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4624 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4625 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4626 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4627 this attribute.
4628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004629 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004630 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004631 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4632 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4633 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4634 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4635 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4636 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004637
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004638 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4639 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4640 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4641 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4642 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4643 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4644 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4645 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004646 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004647 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4648 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4649 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4650 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4651 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4652 the site.
4653
4654 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4655 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4656 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4657 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4658 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4659 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4660 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4661 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4662 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4663 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4664 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4665 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4666 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004667 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004668 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4669 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4670
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004671 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4672 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4673 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4674 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4675 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4676 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4677
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004678 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004679 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4680 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4681 repeated.
4682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004683 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4684 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4685 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4686 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004688 Examples :
4689 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4690 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4691 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004692 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004693
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004694 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004696
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004697declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4698 Declares a capture slot.
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 no | yes | yes | no
4701 Arguments:
4702 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4703
4704 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4705 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4706 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4707 for use in the response.
4708
4709 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004710 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004711 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4712
4713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004714default-server [param*]
4715 Change default options for a server in a backend
4716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4717 yes | no | yes | yes
4718 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004719 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4720 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4721 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4722 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004723
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004724 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004725 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4726
4727 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004728
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004730default_backend <backend>
4731 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 yes | yes | yes | no
4734 Arguments :
4735 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4736
4737 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4738 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4739 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4740 will catch all undetermined requests.
4741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004742 Example :
4743
4744 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4745 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4746 default_backend dynamic
4747
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004748 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004750
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004751description <string>
4752 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 no | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments : string
4756
4757 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4758 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4759 it describes.
4760 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4761
4762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004763disabled
4764 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | yes | yes | yes
4767 Arguments : none
4768
4769 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4770 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4771 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4772 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4773 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4774 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4775 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4776
4777 See also : "enabled"
4778
4779
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004780dispatch <address>:<port>
4781 Set a default server address
4782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4783 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004785
4786 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4787 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4788 during start-up.
4789
4790 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4791 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4792 possible with normal servers.
4793
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004794 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004795 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4796 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4797 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4798 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4799
4800 See also : "server"
4801
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004802
4803dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4804 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | no | yes | yes
4807 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4808
4809 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004810 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004811 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4812 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004813 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004814 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004816enabled
4817 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4819 yes | yes | yes | yes
4820 Arguments : none
4821
4822 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4823 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4824
4825 See also : "disabled"
4826
4827
4828errorfile <code> <file>
4829 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | yes | yes | yes
4832 Arguments :
4833 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004834 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004835 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004836
4837 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004838 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004840 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4841 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842
4843 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4844 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4845 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4846
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004847 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4848
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004849 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4850 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4851 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4852 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4853 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4854 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4855 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4856 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4857 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004859 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4860 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4861 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004862 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004863 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4864
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004865 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004867 Example :
4868 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004869 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004870 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4871 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004873
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004874errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4875 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4876 section.
4877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | yes | yes | yes
4879 Arguments :
4880 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4881
4882 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004883 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004884 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4885 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004886
4887 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4888 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4889 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4890 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4891 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004892 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004893 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4894
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004895 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4896 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004897
4898 Example :
4899 errorfiles generic
4900 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4901
4902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903errorloc <code> <url>
4904errorloc302 <code> <url>
4905 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | yes | yes | yes
4908 Arguments :
4909 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004910 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004911 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912
4913 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4914 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4915 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4916 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004917 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004918
4919 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4920 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4921 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4922
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004923 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4924
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4926 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4927 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4928 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004929 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4931 request.
4932
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004933 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004934
4935
4936errorloc303 <code> <url>
4937 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4939 yes | yes | yes | yes
4940 Arguments :
4941 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004942 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004943 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004944
4945 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4946 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4947 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4948 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004949 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004950
4951 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4952 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4953 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4954
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004955 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4956
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004957 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4958 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4959 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4960 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004961 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004962
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004963 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964
4965
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004966email-alert from <emailaddr>
4967 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004968 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 yes | yes | yes | yes
4971
4972 Arguments :
4973
4974 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4975
4976 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4977 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4978
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004979 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004980 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4981 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004982
4983
4984email-alert level <level>
4985 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4986 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | yes | yes | yes
4989
4990 Arguments :
4991
4992 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4993 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4994 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4995
4996 By default level is alert
4997
4998 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4999 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5000 for the proxy.
5001
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005002 Alerts are sent when :
5003
5004 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5005 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5006 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5007 is notice or lower
5008 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5009 and a health check status update occurs
5010
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005011 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5012 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005013 section 3.6 about mailers.
5014
5015
5016email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5017 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 yes | yes | yes | yes
5020
5021 Arguments :
5022
5023 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5024
5025 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5026 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5027
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005028 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5029 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005030
5031
5032email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5033 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5034 mailers.
5035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | yes | yes | yes
5037
5038 Arguments :
5039
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005040 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005041
5042 By default the systems hostname is used.
5043
5044 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5045 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5046 for the proxy.
5047
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005048 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5049 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005050
5051
5052email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005053 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005054 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | yes | yes | yes
5057
5058 Arguments :
5059
5060 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5061
5062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005065 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005066 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5067
5068
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005069error-log-format <string>
5070 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5072 yes | yes | yes | no
5073
5074 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5075 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5076 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5077 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005078 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5079
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005080 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5081 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5082 string in depth.
5083
5084 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5085 directives.
5086
5087
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005088force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5089 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005091 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005092
5093 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5094 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5095 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5096 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5097 marked down for maintenance operations.
5098
5099 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5100 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5101 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5102 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5103 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5104 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5105 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5106 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5107 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5108
5109 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5110 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5111 is used.
5112
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005113 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005114 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005116
5117filter <name> [param*]
5118 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 no | yes | yes | yes
5121 Arguments :
5122 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5123 referenced in section 9.
5124
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005125 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005126 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005127 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5128 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005129
5130 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5131 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5132
5133 Example:
5134 listen
5135 bind *:80
5136
5137 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5138 filter compression
5139 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5140
5141 compression algo gzip
5142 compression offload
5143
5144 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5145
5146 See also : section 9.
5147
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005148
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005149fullconn <conns>
5150 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | no | yes | yes
5153 Arguments :
5154 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5155 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5156
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005157 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005158 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005159 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005160 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5161 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5162 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5163 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5164 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005165 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005166
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005167 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005168 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005169 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5170 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5171 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005172
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005173 Example :
5174 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5175 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5176 # connections.
5177 backend dynamic
5178 fullconn 10000
5179 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5180 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5181
5182 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5183
5184
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005185hash-balance-factor <factor>
5186 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5188 yes | no | no | yes
5189 Arguments :
5190 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5191 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005192 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005193
5194 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5195 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5196 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5197 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5198 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5199 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5200 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5201
5202 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5203 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5204 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5205 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5206 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5207
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005208 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5209 consistent hashing mechanism.
5210
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005211 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5212
5213
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005214hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005215 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5217 yes | no | yes | yes
5218 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005219 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5220 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005221
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005222 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5223 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5224 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5225 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5226 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5227 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5228 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5229 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5230 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5231 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005232
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5234 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5235 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5236 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5237 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5238 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5239 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5240 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5241 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5242 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5243 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5244 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5245 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005246 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5247 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005248
5249 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5250
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005251 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005252 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5253 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5254 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005255 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5256 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5257 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005258
5259 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5260 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005261 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5262 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5263 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5264 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5265
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005266 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005267 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5268 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5269 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5270 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5271 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5272 parameter.
5273
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005274 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5275 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5276 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5277 used on strings.
5278
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005279 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5280
5281 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5282 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5283 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5284 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5285 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5286 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5287 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5288 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5289 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5290 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5291 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5292 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005293
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005294 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5295 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5296 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005297
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005298 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005299
5300
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005301http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5302 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5303 ones).
5304
5305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005306 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005307
5308 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5309 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5310 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5311 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5312 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5313 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5314
5315 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5316 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5317 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5318
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005319 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5320 supported:
5321 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5322 - allow
5323 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5324 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5325 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5326 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5327 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5328 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
5329 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
5330 - strict-mode { on | off }
5331 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5332
5333 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005334
5335 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5336 instance.
5337
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005338 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5339 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5340 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5341 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5342 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5343 a defaults section defining such rules.
5344
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005345 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5346 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5347 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5348
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005349 Example:
5350 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5351 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5352 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5353
5354http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5355
5356 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005357 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5358 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005359
5360http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5361
5362 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005363 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005364
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005365http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005366
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005367 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5368 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005369
5370http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5372
5373 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5374
5375 Example:
5376 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5377
5378 # applied to:
5379 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5380
5381 # outputs:
5382 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5383
5384 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5385
5386http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5387 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5388
5389 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5390
5391 Example:
5392 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5393
5394 # applied to:
5395 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5396
5397 # outputs:
5398 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5399
5400http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005402 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5403 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5404 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5405 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005406
5407http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5409
5410 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005411 between 100 and 999. Plese refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
5412 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005413
5414http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005415http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005417 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5418 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5419 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005420
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005421http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005423 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5424 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005425
5426http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5427
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005428 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5429 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005430
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005431
5432http-check comment <string>
5433 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5434 it fails.
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | no | yes | yes
5437
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005438 Arguments :
5439 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5440 rule fails.
5441
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005442 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5443 user-friendly error reporting.
5444
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005446 "http-check expect".
5447
5448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5450 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005451 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005452 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5454 yes | no | yes | yes
5455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005456 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005457 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005460 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461
5462 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5463 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5464 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5465 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5466
5467 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5468
5469 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5470
5471 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5472
5473 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5474
5475 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5476
5477 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5478 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5479 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5480 is used.
5481
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005482 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5483 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5484 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5485 haproxy -vv.
5486
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5488
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005489 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5490 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5491 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5492 different ports or with different servers.
5493
5494 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5495 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5496 the port with a "http-check connect".
5497
5498 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5499 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5500 do.
5501
5502 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5503 unset-var or comment rules.
5504
5505 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005506 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5507 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5508 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5509 option httpchk
5510
5511 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005512 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005513 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005514 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005515 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005516 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005517
5518 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5519
5520 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005523http-check disable-on-404
5524 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005526 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005527 Arguments : none
5528
5529 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5530 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5531 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5532 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5533 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5534 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5535 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5536 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5538 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005539 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5540 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5541 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005542
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005543 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005544
5545
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005546http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005547 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5548 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5549 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005550 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005552 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005554 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005555 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5556
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005557 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5558 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5559 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5560 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5561 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5562 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5563 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5564 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5565 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5566 result is always conclusive.
5567
5568 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5569 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5570 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005571 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5572 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005573 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5574 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005575 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5576 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5577 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005578
5579 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5580 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005581 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5582 supported :
5583 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5584 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005585 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5586 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5587 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5588 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5589 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005590
5591 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5592 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005593 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5594 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5595 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5596 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5598
5599 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5600 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5601 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5602 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5603
5604 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5605 informational message reported in logs if an error
5606 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5607 log-format string.
5608
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005609 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005610 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5611 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005612 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5613 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5614 details on the supported keywords.
5615
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005616 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5617 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5618 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5619 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620
5621 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5622 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5623 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5624 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5625 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5626
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005627 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5628 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5629 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5630 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5631 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5632 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5633 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005634
5635 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005636 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5638 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5639 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5640 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5641
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005642 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5643 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005644 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5645 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5646 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5647 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5648 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5649 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5650 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5651 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005652 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5653 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5654 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5655 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5656 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5657 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5658 insensitive on the header names.
5659
5660 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5661 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5662 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5663 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5664 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5665 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005666
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005668 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005669 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5670 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5671 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5672 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5673 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005674 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 trace).
5676
5677 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005678 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005679 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5680 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5681 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5682 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5683 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005684 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005686 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5687 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5688 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5689 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5690 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5691 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5692
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005693 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005694 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005695 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5696 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5697 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5698 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5699 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5700 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5701
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005702 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5703 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5704 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5705 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5706 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005707
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005708 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5709 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5710
5711 Examples :
5712 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005713 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005715 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5716 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5717
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005719 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
5721 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005722 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005723
5724 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005725 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005726
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005727 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005728 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005729
5730
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005731http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005732 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5733 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005734 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5735 health checks.
5736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 yes | no | yes | yes
5738 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005739 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005741 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5742 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5743 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5744 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5745 to invent non-standard ones.
5746
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005747 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5748 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5749 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5750 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5751
5752 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5753 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5754 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5755 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005756
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005757 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005759 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005760 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5761 to add it.
5762
5763 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5764 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5765 to the log-format rules.
5766
5767 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5768 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5769 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005770
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005771 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5772 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5773 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5774 request.
5775
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5777 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005779 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5780 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5781 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5782 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005783 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005784
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005785 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005786 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5787 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005788
5789 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5790 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5791 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5792 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5793 configured request authority.
5794
5795 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5796 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005797
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005798 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005799
5800
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005801http-check send-state
5802 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5804 yes | no | yes | yes
5805 Arguments : none
5806
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005807 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005808 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005809 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5810 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5811 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005812
5813 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5814 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5815 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5816 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5817 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005818 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5819 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5820 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5821
5822 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5823 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5824 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5825
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005826 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5827 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5828 checked in multiple backends.
5829
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005830 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005831 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5832
5833 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5834 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5835 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5836 one fails.
5837
5838 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5839 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5840 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5841
5842 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5843 server's queue.
5844
5845 Example of a header received by the application server :
5846 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5847 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005849 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5850 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005851
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005852
5853http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005854http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005855 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | no | yes | yes
5858
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005859 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5861 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5864 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5865 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5866 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5867 and '-'.
5868
5869 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5870
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005871 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5872 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5873
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005874 Examples :
5875 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005876 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005877
5878
5879http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005880 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 yes | no | yes | yes
5883
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005884 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005885 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5886 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5887 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5888 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5889 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5890 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5891 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5892 and '-'.
5893
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005894 Examples :
5895 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005896
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005897
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005898http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5899 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5900 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5901 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5902 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 yes | yes | yes | yes
5905 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005906 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005907 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005908 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005909 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005910
5911 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5912 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5913 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5914 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5915
5916 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5917 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5918 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5919 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5920
5921 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5922 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5923 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5924 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5925 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5926 chroot is performed.
5927
5928 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5929 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5930 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5931 considered.
5932
5933 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5934 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5935 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5936 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5937 considered as a raw string.
5938
5939 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5940 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5941 "content-type".
5942
5943 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5944 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5945 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5946 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5947 evaluated as a log-format string.
5948
5949 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5950 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5951 argument to "content-type".
5952
5953 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5954 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5955 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5956 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5957
5958 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5959 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5960 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5961 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5962 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5963 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5964 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5965 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5966
5967 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5968 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5969 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5970
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005971 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5972 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5973 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5974 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5975 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5976
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005977 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5978 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5979
5980
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005981http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005982 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5983
5984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005985 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005986
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005987 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5988 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5989 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5990 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5991 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005992
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005993 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5994 supported:
5995 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
5996 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5997 - allow
5998 - auth [realm <realm>]
5999 - cache-use <name>
6000 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6001 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6002 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6003 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6004 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6005 - disable-l7-retry
6006 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6007 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6008 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6009 - redirect <rule>
6010 - reject
6011 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6012 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6013 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6014 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6015 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6016 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6017 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6018 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6019 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6020 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6021 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6022 - set-dst <expr>
6023 - set-dst-port <expr>
6024 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6025 - set-log-level <level>
6026 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6027 - set-mark <mark>
6028 - set-method <fmt>
6029 - set-nice <nice>
6030 - set-path <fmt>
6031 - set-pathq <fmt>
6032 - set-priority-class <expr>
6033 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6034 - set-query <fmt>
6035 - set-src <expr>
6036 - set-src-port <expr>
6037 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6038 - set-tos <tos>
6039 - set-uri <fmt>
6040 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
6041 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
6042 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6043 - silent-drop
6044 - strict-mode { on | off }
6045 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6046 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6047 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6048 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6049 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6050 - use-service <service-name>
6051 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6052 - wait-for-handshake
6053 - cache-use <name>
6054
6055 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006058
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006059 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6060 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6061 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6062 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6063 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6064 a defaults section defining such rules.
6065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006066 Example:
6067 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6068 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6069 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 http-request allow if nagios
6072 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6073 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6074 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 Example:
6077 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6078 acl add path /addacl
6079 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006083 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6084 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086 Example:
6087 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6088 acl setmap path /setmap
6089 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6094 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6097 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6102 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6103 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6104 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6105 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6106 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6107 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6108 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6113 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6114 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6115 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6116 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6117 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6118 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6119 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006123 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006124 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006128 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6129 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6130 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6131 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6132 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006133
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006134 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6135 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6136 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6137 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6138 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6139 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6140 instead.
6141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 Example:
6143 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6144 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006145
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006146http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006147
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006148 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006150http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6151 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6154 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6155 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6156 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6157 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6158 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6159 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6160 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6161 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6164 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6165 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006166 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6167
6168 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6169 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6170 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6171 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006175 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6176 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6177 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6178 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6179 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6180 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006181
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006182http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006183
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006184 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6185 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6186 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6187 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6188 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006190http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6193 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6194 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6195 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6196 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6197 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006198
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006199http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6200http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6201 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6202 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6203 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006205
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006206 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6207 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6208 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006209 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006210 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6211 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6212 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006213 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006214 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006215
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006216http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6217 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6218 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6219 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6220
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006221http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6222 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006223
6224 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6225 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6226 pointed by <resolvers>.
6227 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6228 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6229 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6230 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6231 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6232 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6233 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6234 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6235 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6236 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6237 to 0.0.0.0.
6238
6239 Example:
6240 resolvers mydns
6241 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6242 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6243 timeout retry 1s
6244 hold valid 10s
6245 hold nx 3s
6246 hold other 3s
6247 hold obsolete 0s
6248 accepted_payload_size 8192
6249
6250 frontend fe
6251 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6252 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6253 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6254
6255 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6256 # which mean DNS resolution error
6257 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6258
6259 default_backend be
6260
6261 backend b_503
6262 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6263 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6264 # 503 error page to end users
6265
6266 backend be
6267 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6268 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6269 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6270 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6271 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6272
6273 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6274 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6275
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006276http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6277
6278 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6279 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6280 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6281 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006282 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6283 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006284
6285 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6286
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006287http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006288http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006289http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006290http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006291http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006292http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006293http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006294http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6295http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006296
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006297 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6298
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006299 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006300 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6301 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6302 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6303 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006304
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006305 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6306 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6307 the supported backend.
6308
6309 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6310 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6311 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6312 number of segments in the path.
6313
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006314 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6315 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6316 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6317 when improperly combined.
6318
6319 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6320 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6321 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6322 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6323 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6324
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006325 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006326
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006327 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6328
6329 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6330 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6331
6332 Example:
6333 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6334
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006335 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6336
6337 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6338 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6339
6340 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6341 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6342
6343 Example:
6344 - /#foo -> /
6345
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006346 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6347 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006348
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006349 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6350 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6351
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006352 Example:
6353 - /. -> /
6354 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6355 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6356 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006357
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006358 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6359 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6360
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006361 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006362 their preceding segment.
6363
6364 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6365 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6366
6367 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6368 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006369
6370 Example:
6371 - /foo/../ -> /
6372 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6373 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6374 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006375 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006376 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006377 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006378
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006379 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6380 removed as well:
6381
6382 Example:
6383 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6384 - /bar/../../ -> /
6385
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006386 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6387 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006388
6389 Example:
6390 - // -> /
6391 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6392
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006393 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6394 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6395
6396 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6397 ".", "_", and "~".
6398
6399 Example:
6400 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6401 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6402 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6403 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6404
6405 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6406 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6407
6408 Example:
6409 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6410 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6411
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006412 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006413 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006414
6415 Example:
6416 - /%6f -> /%6F
6417 - /%zz -> /%zz
6418
6419 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6420 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6421
6422 Example:
6423 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6424
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006425 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006426 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6427 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6428
6429 Example:
6430 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6431 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6432 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006434http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006436 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6437 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6438 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6439 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6440 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006442http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006444 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6445 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6446 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6447 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006449http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6450 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006451
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006452 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006453 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6454 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6455 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6456 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6457 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006459 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6460 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6461 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6462 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6463 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006464
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006465 Example:
6466 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6467
6468 # applied to:
6469 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6470
6471 # outputs:
6472 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6473
6474 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006475
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006476 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6477
6478 # applied to:
6479 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006481 # outputs:
6482 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006483
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006484http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6485 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6486
6487 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6488 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006489 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6490 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6491 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006492
6493 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6494 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6495 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6496
6497 Example:
6498 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6499 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6500
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006501 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6502 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6503 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6504 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6505
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006506http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508
6509 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6510 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6511 query-string are replaced.
6512
6513 Example:
6514 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6515 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6516
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006517http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6518 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6519
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006520 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6521 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6522 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6523 against.
6524
6525 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6526 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6527 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006528
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006529 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6530 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6531 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6532 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6533 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6534 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6535 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6536 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6537 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006538 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6539 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006540
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006541 Example:
6542 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6543 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006544
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006545 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6546 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006550
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006551 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6552 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6553 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6554 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006555
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006556 Example:
6557 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006558
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006559 # applied to:
6560 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006561
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006562 # outputs:
6563 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006564
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006565http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6566 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6567 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006568 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006569 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6570
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006571 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006572 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6573 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006574 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006575 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006576 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006577 are followed to create the response :
6578
6579 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6580 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6581 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6582 ignored.
6583
6584 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6585 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006586 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006587 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6588 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006589
6590 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6591 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6592 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006593 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006594 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006595
6596 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6597 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6598 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006599 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006600 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006601 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602
6603 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6604 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6605 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6606 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6607 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6608 as a raw content.
6609
6610 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6611 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6612 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6613 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6614 considered as a raw string.
6615
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006616 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006617 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6618 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6619 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6620
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006621 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6622 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006623 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006624
6625 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6626
6627 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006628 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006629 if { path /ping }
6630
6631 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6632 if { path /favicon.ico }
6633
6634 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6635 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6636 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6637
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006638http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6639
6640 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6641 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6642 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6643 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6644 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6645 at this index.
6646 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6647 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6650http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6653 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6654 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006655
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006656http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6657 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6658 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6659 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6660 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6661 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6662 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6663 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6664 at this index.
6665 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6666 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6667
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006668http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006670
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006671 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6672 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6673 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6674 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006675
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006676http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6677 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6678
6679 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6680 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6681 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6682 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6683 agent name must be used.
6684
6685 Arguments:
6686 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6687
6688 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6689 configuration.
6690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6694 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6695 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6696 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6697 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006699 Arguments:
6700 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6701 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006703 Example:
6704 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6705 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6708 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6713 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6714 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006716 Arguments:
6717 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6718 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 Example:
6721 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6722 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6725 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6726 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006728http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006730 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6731 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6732 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6733 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6734 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736 Example:
6737 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6738 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6739 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6740 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6741 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6742 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6743 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6744 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6745 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6750 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6751 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6752 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6753 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006755http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6756 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6760 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6761 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6762 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6763 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6764 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6765 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6766 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006768http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006769
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006770 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6771 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6772 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6773 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6774 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6775 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6776 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006777 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6778 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006780http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6783 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6784 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006786http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006788 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6789 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6790 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6791 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6792 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6793 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6794 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6795 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006797http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006799 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6800 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6801 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6802 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6803 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6804 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006806 Example :
6807 # prepend the host name before the path
6808 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006809
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006810http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6811
6812 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6813 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6814 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006816http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006818 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6819 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6820 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6821 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6822 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006824http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006826 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6827 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6828 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6829 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6830 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6831 values have higher priority.
6832 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6833 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6834 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6835 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6836 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006838http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6841 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6842 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6843 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6844 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6845 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6846 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006848 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006849
6850 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006851 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6852 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6855 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6856 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6857 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006858 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6859 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006860
6861 Arguments :
6862 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6863 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006864
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006865 See also "option forwardfor".
6866
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006867 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006868 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6869 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6870
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006871 # After the masking this will track connections
6872 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6873 http-request track-sc0 src
6874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006875 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6876 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6877
6878http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6879
6880 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6881 expression.
6882
6883 Arguments:
6884 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6885 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006886
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006887 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006888 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6889 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6890
6891 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6892 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6893 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6894
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006895http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006896 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6897
6898 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6899 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6900 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6901 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6902 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6903
6904 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6905 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6906 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6907 results.
6908
6909 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006910 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6911 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006913http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6914
6915 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6916 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6917 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6918 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6919 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6920 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6921 information from the request.
6922
6923 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6924
6925http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926
6927 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6928 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6929 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6930 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6931 path and the query string.
6932 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6933
6934http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006935http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006936
6937 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6938 inline.
6939
6940 Arguments:
6941 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6942 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6943 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6944 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6945 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6946 (request and response)
6947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6948 processing
6949 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6950 processing
6951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6952 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6953 and '_'.
6954
6955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6956 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006957
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006958 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6959 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6960
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006961 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006962 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006963 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006965http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6966
6967 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6968 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6969 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6970 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6971 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6972 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6973 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6974 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6975 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6976 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6977 action.
6978 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6979 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6980 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6981 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6982 you fully understand how it works.
6983
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006984http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006985
6986 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6987 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6988 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6989 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6990 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006991 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006992 processing.
6993
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006994 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006995 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6996 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6997 rules evaluation.
6998
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006999http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7000http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7001 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7002 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7003 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7004 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007005
7006 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7007 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7008 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007009 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7010 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7011 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7012 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7013 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7014 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007015 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007016 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7017 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7018 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007019 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007020 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7021 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7022 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7023 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7024 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007025
7026http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7027http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7028http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7029
7030 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7031 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7032 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7033 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007034 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007035 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7036 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7037 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7038 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7039 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7040 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7041 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7042
7043 Arguments :
7044 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7045 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7046 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7047 select which table entry to update the counters.
7048
7049 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7050 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7051 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7052 that table until the session ends.
7053
7054 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7055 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7056 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7057 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7058 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7059 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7060 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7061 useful information.
7062
7063 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7064 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7065 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7066 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7067 checks that make use of it.
7068
7069http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7070
7071 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007072
7073 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007074 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007075
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007076http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7077
7078 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7079 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7080 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7081 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7082 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7083 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7084
7085 Arguments :
7086 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7087
7088 Example:
7089 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7090
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007091http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7092 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7093
7094 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7095 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7096 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7097 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7098 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7099 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7100 http-buffer-request".
7101
7102 Arguments :
7103
7104 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7105 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7106
7107 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007108 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007109 bytes.
7110
7111 Example:
7112 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7113
7114 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007116http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007118 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7119 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7120 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007121
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007123http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007124 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7125
7126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007127 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007128
7129 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7130 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7131 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7132 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7133 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7134 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7135
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007136 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7137 supported:
7138 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7139 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7140 - allow
7141 - cache-store <name>
7142 - capture <sample> id <id>
7143 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7144 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7145 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7146 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7147 - redirect <rule>
7148 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7149 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7150 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7151 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7152 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7153 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7154 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7155 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7156 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7157 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7158 - set-log-level <level>
7159 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7160 - set-mark <mark>
7161 - set-nice <nice>
7162 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7163 - set-tos <tos>
7164 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
7165 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
7166 - silent-drop
7167 - strict-mode { on | off }
7168 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7169 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7170 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7171 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7172 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7173
7174 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007177
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007178 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7179 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7180 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7181 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7182 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7183 a defaults section defining such rules.
7184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007185 Example:
7186 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007188 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7191 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193 Example:
7194 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007198 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7199 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007201 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7202 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007205
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007206 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7207 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007209http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007211 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007212 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7213 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007217 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7218 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007219
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007220http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007221
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007222 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007225
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007226 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7227 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7228 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7229 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7230 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7231 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7232 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007234 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7235 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7236 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7237 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7238 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007239
7240 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7241 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7242 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7243 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007246
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007247 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7248 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007249
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007250http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007251
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007252 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7253 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007255http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007256
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007257 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7258 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007259
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007260http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7261http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7262 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7263 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7264 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7265 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007266
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007267 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7268 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7269 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007270 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007271 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7272 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7273 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007274 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007275 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007277http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007279 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7280 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7281 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7282 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7283 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7284 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007286http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007288
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007289 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7290 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007292 Example:
7293 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007295 # applied to:
7296 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007298 # outputs:
7299 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007303http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007305
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007306 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007307 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007309 Example:
7310 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007312 # applied to:
7313 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315 # outputs:
7316 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007317
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007318http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7319 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7320 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007321 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7323
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007324 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7325 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7326 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007327
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007328http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007329http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7330http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007331
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007332 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7333 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7334 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7335 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007336
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007337http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007338 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007339http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007341http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007343
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007344 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7345 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7346 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007347
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007348http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007351 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7352 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007354http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007355
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007356 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7357 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7358 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7359 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7362
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007363 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7364 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007365
7366http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7367
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007368 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7369 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007370
7371http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007373 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7374 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7375 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007376
7377http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7378
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007379 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7380 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007381
7382http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7384
7385 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7386 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7387 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7388 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007389
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007390 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7392 http-response set-status 431
7393 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7394 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007396http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007399 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7400 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007401
7402http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007403http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007404
7405 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007406 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7407 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007408
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007409http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007410
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007411 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7412 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007413 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7414 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007415
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007416http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007417
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007418 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7419 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007421http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7422http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7423http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007424
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007425 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7426 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7427 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428
7429http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7430
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007432 about <var-name>.
7433
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007434http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7436
7437 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007438 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7439 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007440
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007441
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007442http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7443 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7444
7445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7446 yes | no | yes | yes
7447
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007448 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007449 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7450 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7451 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007452
7453 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7454
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007455 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7456 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7457 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7458 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7459 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7460 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7461 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007462 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007463 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7464 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007465
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007466 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7467 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7468 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7469 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7470 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7471 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7472 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007473 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7474 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7475 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7476 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7477 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7478 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007479
7480 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7481 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7482 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7483 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7484 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7485 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7486 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7487 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007488 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007489 downsides of rare connection failures.
7490
7491 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7492 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7493 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7494 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7495 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7496 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007497 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007498 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7499 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7500 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7501 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7502 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7503
7504 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007505 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7506 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7507 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7508 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007509
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007510 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7511 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007512
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007513 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007514
7515 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7516 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7517 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7518
7519 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7520
7521
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007522http-send-name-header [<header>]
7523 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007526 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007527 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7528
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007529 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7530 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7531 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7532 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7533 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7534 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7535 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7536 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7537 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7538 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7539 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7540 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7541 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7542 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7543 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7544 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545
7546 See also : "server"
7547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007548id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007549 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 no | yes | yes | yes
7552 Arguments : none
7553
7554 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7555 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7556 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007557
7558
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007559ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7560 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007562 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007563
7564 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7565 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7566 and running).
7567
7568 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7569 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7570 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007571 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007572 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7573
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007574 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7575 "unless" condition is met.
7576
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007577 Example:
7578 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7579 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7580 ignore-persist if url_static
7581
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007582 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7583
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007584load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7585 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 yes | no | yes | yes
7588
7589 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7590 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7591 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007592 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007593 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007594 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7595 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7596 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007598 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007599 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007600 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007601
7602 Arguments:
7603 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7604 named "server-state-file".
7605
7606 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7607 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7608 name is used as a file name.
7609
7610 none don't load any stat for this backend
7611
7612 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007613 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7614 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7615 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007617 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618
7619 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7620 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7621
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007622 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007624 global
7625 stats socket /tmp/socket
7626 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007627
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007628 defaults
7629 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007630
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007631 backend bk
7632 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7633 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007634
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007635
7636 Then one can run :
7637
7638 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7639
7640 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7641
7642 1
7643 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7644 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7645 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7646
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007647 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007648
7649 global
7650 stats socket /tmp/socket
7651 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7652
7653 defaults
7654 load-server-state-from-file local
7655
7656 backend bk
7657 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7658 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7659
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007660
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007661 Then one can run :
7662
7663 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7664
7665 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7666
7667 1
7668 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7669 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7670 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7671
7672 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7673 "show servers state"
7674
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007676log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007677log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007678 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007679no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007680 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7682 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007683
7684 Prefix :
7685 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7686 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7687 prefix does not allow arguments.
7688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007689 Arguments :
7690 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7691 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7692 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7693 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7694 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7695 parameter.
7696
7697 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7698 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7699
7700 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7701 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7702 standard syslog port).
7703
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007704 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7705 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7706 standard syslog port).
7707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007708 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7709 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7710 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007711 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007712
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007713 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7714 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7715 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7716 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7717 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7718 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7719 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7720 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7721 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7722 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7723 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7724 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007725 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007726 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7727 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7728 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007729 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7730 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007731
7732 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7733 and "fd@2", see above.
7734
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007735 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7736 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7737 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7738 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7739 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7740 having the logs instantly available.
7741
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007742 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7743 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7744 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7745
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007746 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7747 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007748
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007749 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7750 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7751 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7752 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7753 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7754 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7755 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7756 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7757 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7758 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007759 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007760
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007761 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7762 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7763 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7764 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7765 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7766
7767 <sample_size>
7768 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7769 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7770 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7771 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7772 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7773
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007774 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7775 one of the following :
7776
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007777 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7778 field is stripped. This is the default.
7779 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7780 rfc3164.
7781
7782 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007783 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7784
7785 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7786 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7787
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007788 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7789 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7790 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7791 designed to be used with a local log server.
7792
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007793 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7794 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7795 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7796 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7797 systemd logger consumes.
7798
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007799 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7800 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7801 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7802 used with a local log server.
7803
7804 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7805 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7806 designed to be used with a local log server.
7807
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007808 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7809 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7810 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7811 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007813 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7814
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007815 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7816 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7817 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7818
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007819 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7820 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7821 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7822 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007823
7824 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7825 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7826 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007827 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7828 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7829 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7830 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7831 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007832
7833 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7834
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007835 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7836 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7837 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007838
7839 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7840 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7841 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7842 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7843
7844 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7845 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007846
7847 Example :
7848 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007849 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7850 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7851 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007852 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007853 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7854 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007855 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007856
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007857
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007858log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007859 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007862
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007863 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7864 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7865 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7866 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7867 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007868 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7869 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007870
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007871 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7872 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007873
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007874log-format-sd <string>
7875 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7877 yes | yes | yes | no
7878
7879 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7880 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7881 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7882 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7883 which covers the log format string in depth.
7884
7885 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7886 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7887
7888 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7889 log format to "rfc5424".
7890
7891 Example :
7892 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7893
7894
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007895log-tag <string>
7896 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7897 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7898 yes | yes | yes | yes
7899
7900 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7901 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007902 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007903 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7904 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7905 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7906 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7907 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7908 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007909
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007910max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7911 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7912 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7913 yes | no | yes | yes
7914
7915 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7916 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7917 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7918 servers.
7919
7920 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007921 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007922 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7923 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7924 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007925 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007926 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7927 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7928 picking a different server.
7929
7930 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7931 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7932 even if they have to be queued.
7933
7934 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7935 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7936
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007937max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7938 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7939 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7940 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007942maxconn <conns>
7943 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 yes | yes | yes | no
7946 Arguments :
7947 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7948 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7949 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7950 closes.
7951
7952 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007953 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007954 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7955 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007956 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7957 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7958 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7959 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007960
7961 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7962 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7963 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7964
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007965 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7966 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007967
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007968 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7969
7970
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007971mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007972 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | yes
7975 Arguments :
7976 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7977 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7978 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7979 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7980
7981 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7982 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7983 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7984 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7985 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7986
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007987 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7988 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7989 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007991 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007992 defaults http_instances
7993 mode http
7994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007995
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007996monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007997 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008000 Arguments :
8001 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8002 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008003 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008004 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8005 backend and its backup.
8006
8007 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8008 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8009 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8010 servers in a list of backends.
8011
8012 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8013 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8014 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008015 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008016 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8017 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008018 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008019 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8020 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008021
8022 Example:
8023 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008024 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008025 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8026 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8027 monitor-uri /site_alive
8028 monitor fail if site_dead
8029
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008030 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008031
8032
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008033monitor-uri <uri>
8034 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8036 yes | yes | yes | no
8037 Arguments :
8038 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8039 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8040
8041 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8042 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8043 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8044 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8045 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8046 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8047 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8048 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8049
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008050 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008051 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8052 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8053 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8054 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8055 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8056 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008057
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008058 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8059 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8060 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8061 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008063 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008064 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008065 frontend www
8066 mode http
8067 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8068
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008069 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008072option abortonclose
8073no option abortonclose
8074 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8076 yes | no | yes | yes
8077 Arguments : none
8078
8079 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8080 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8081 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8082 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008083 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008084 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8085 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8086 encountered while delivering the response.
8087
8088 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8089 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8090 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8091 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8092 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8093 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008094 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008095 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008096 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008097 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8098 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8099 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008101 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8102 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008103 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8104 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8105 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8106 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8107 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8108 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008109 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008110
8111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8113
8114 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8115
8116
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008117option accept-invalid-http-request
8118no option accept-invalid-http-request
8119 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8121 yes | yes | yes | no
8122 Arguments : none
8123
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008124 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008125 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008126 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008127 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8128 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8129 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8130 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8131 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008132 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8133 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8134 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8135 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008136 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008137 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008138 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8139 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8140 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008141
8142 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8143 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8144 been confirmed.
8145
8146 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8147 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008148 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8149 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008150 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8151
8152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8154
8155 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8156 stats socket.
8157
8158
8159option accept-invalid-http-response
8160no option accept-invalid-http-response
8161 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 yes | no | yes | yes
8164 Arguments : none
8165
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008166 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008167 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008168 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008169 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8170 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8171 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8172 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8173 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008174 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8175 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8176 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008177
8178 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8179 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8180 been confirmed.
8181
8182 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8183 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8184 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8185 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8186
8187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8189
8190 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8191 stats socket.
8192
8193
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008194option allbackups
8195no option allbackups
8196 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8198 yes | no | yes | yes
8199 Arguments : none
8200
8201 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8202 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8203 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8204 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8205 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8206 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8207 order between the backup servers anymore.
8208
8209 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8210 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8211
8212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8214
8215
8216option checkcache
8217no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008218 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 yes | no | yes | yes
8221 Arguments : none
8222
8223 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8224 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008225 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008226 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8227 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008228 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008229
8230 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008231 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008232 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008233 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8234 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008235 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008236 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008237 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8238 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008239 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008240 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8241 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008242 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008243 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8244 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8245 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8246 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8247 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8248 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8249 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8250 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8251 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8252
8253 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008254 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8255 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8256 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8257 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008258
8259 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8260 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008261 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008262 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008263
8264 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8265 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8266
8267
8268option clitcpka
8269no option clitcpka
8270 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 yes | yes | yes | no
8273 Arguments : none
8274
8275 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8276 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008277 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008278 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8279
8280 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8281 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8282 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8283 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8284
8285 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8286 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8287 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8288 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8289 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8290
8291 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8292
8293 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8294 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8295 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8296
8297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8299
8300 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8301
8302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008303option contstats
8304 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | yes | yes | no
8307 Arguments : none
8308
8309 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8310 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8311 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008312 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008313 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8314 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8315 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8316 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8317 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008318
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008319option disable-h2-upgrade
8320no option disable-h2-upgrade
8321 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8322 connection.
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | no
8325 Arguments : none
8326
8327 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8328 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8329 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8330 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008331 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8332 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8333 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8334 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8335 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8336 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008337
8338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008340
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008341option dontlog-normal
8342no option dontlog-normal
8343 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | no
8346 Arguments : none
8347
8348 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8349 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8350 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8351 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8352 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8353 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8354 logged.
8355
8356 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8357 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8358 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008360 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008361 logging.
8362
8363
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008364option dontlognull
8365no option dontlognull
8366 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 yes | yes | yes | no
8369 Arguments : none
8370
8371 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8372 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8373 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8374 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8375 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8376 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008377 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8378 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8379 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008380
8381 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008382 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008383 would not be logged.
8384
8385 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8386 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8387
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008388 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008389 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008390
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008391
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008392option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008393 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | yes | yes | yes
8396 Arguments :
8397 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8398 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008399 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008400 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008401
8402 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8403 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8404 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8405 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8406 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8407 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8408 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008409 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8410 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8411 possible that the client has already brought one.
8412
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008413 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008414 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008415 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008416 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008417 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008418 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008419
8420 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8421 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8422 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8423 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8424 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8425 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008426 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008428 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8429 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008430 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008431 are under the control of the end-user.
8432
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008433 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008434 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8435 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008436 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8437 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8438 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008439
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008440 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008441 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8442 frontend www
8443 mode http
8444 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8445
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008446 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8447 backend www
8448 mode http
8449 option forwardfor header X-Client
8450
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008451 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008452 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008453
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008454
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008455option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8456no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8457 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | yes | yes | no
8460 Arguments : none
8461
8462 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8463 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8464 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8465 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8466 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8467 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8468 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8469
8470 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8471 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8472 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8473 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8474 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8475 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8476 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8477 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8478 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8479 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8480
8481 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8482
8483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8485
8486 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8487 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8488
8489
8490option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8491no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8492 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8494 yes | no | yes | yes
8495 Arguments : none
8496
8497 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8498 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8499 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8500 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8501 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8502 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8503 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8504
8505 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8506 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8507 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8508 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8509 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8510 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8511 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8512 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8513 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8514 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8515
8516 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8517
8518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8520
8521 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8522 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8523
8524
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008525option http-buffer-request
8526no option http-buffer-request
8527 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8529 yes | yes | yes | yes
8530 Arguments : none
8531
8532 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8533 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8534 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8535 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8536 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8537 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008538 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8539 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8540 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8541 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008542
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008543 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8544 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008545
8546
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008547option http-ignore-probes
8548no option http-ignore-probes
8549 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | yes | yes | no
8552 Arguments : none
8553
8554 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8555 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8556 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8557 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8558 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8559 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8560 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8561 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8562 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8564 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008565 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8566
8567 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8568 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8569 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8570 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8571 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8572 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8573 are often the only way to detect them.
8574
8575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8577
8578 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8579
8580
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008581option http-keep-alive
8582no option http-keep-alive
8583 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8585 yes | yes | yes | yes
8586 Arguments : none
8587
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008588 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8589 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008590 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8591 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008592 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8593 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8594 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008595
8596 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8597 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008598 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8599 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8600 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8601 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8602 situations where this option may be useful :
8603
8604 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008605 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008606
8607 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8608 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8609
8610 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8611 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8612 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8613 request.
8614
8615 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8616 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008617 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8618 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8619 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008620
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008621 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8622 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8623 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8624 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8625 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8626 not set.
8627
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008628 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8629 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8630 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008631
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008632 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008633 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008634 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008635
8636
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008637option http-no-delay
8638no option http-no-delay
8639 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 yes | yes | yes | yes
8642 Arguments : none
8643
8644 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8645 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8646 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8647 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8648 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8649 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8650 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008651 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008652 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8653 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8654 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8655 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8656 affected.
8657
8658 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8659 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8660 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8661 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8662 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8663 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8664 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8665 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8666 latency environments.
8667
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008668 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8669
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008670
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008671option http-pretend-keepalive
8672no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008673 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008675 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008676 Arguments : none
8677
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008678 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008679 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8680 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8681 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008682 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008683 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8684 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8685 consider the response complete.
8686
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008687 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008688 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008689 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008690 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008691 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008692 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8693
8694 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8695 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8696 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8697 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008698 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8699 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008700 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8701
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008702 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8703 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8704 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8705 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8706 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8707 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008708
8709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8711
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008712 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008713 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008714
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008715
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008716option http-server-close
8717no option http-server-close
8718 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8720 yes | yes | yes | yes
8721 Arguments : none
8722
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008723 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8724 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8725 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8726 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008727 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8728 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8729 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8730 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8731 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8732 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8733 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8734 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8735 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8736 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8737 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008738
8739 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8740 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8741 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8742 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008743 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8744 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008745
8746 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8747 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008748 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8749 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8750 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008751
8752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8754
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008755 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8756 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008757
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008758option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008759no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008760 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8762 yes | yes | yes | no
8763 Arguments : none
8764
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008765 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008766 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8767 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8768 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8769 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8770 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008771 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008772
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008773 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008774 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008775 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8776 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8777 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008778
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008779 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8780 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8781 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8782 front of an existing proxy.
8783
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008784 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008786 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008788option httpchk
8789option httpchk <uri>
8790option httpchk <method> <uri>
8791option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008792 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8794 yes | no | yes | yes
8795 Arguments :
8796 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8797 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8798 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8799 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8800 ones.
8801
8802 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8803 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8804 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8805
8806 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8807 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8808 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008809 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008810
8811 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8812 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8813 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8814 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8815 the lack of any response.
8816
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008817 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8818 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8819 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8820 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8821
8822 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8823 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8824 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008825
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008826 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8827 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008828 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008829 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008830 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008831
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008832 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8833 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8834 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8835 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8836
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008837 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008838 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8839 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8840 backend https_relay
8841 mode tcp
8842 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8843 http-check send hdr Host www
8844 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008845
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008846 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8847 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8848 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008849
8850
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008851option httpclose
8852no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008853 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 yes | yes | yes | yes
8856 Arguments : none
8857
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008858 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8859 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8860 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8861 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008862 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008863
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008864 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8865 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008866 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008867 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8868 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008869
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008870 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8871 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8872 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008873
8874 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8875 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008876 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8877 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8878 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008879
8880 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8881 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8882
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008883 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008884
8885
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008886option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008887 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008889 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008890 Arguments :
8891 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8892 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8893 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008894 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008895 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008896
8897 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8898 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8899 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8900 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8901 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8902 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8903 ports.
8904
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008905 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8906 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008907
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008908 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008910 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008911
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008912option httpslog
8913 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 yes | yes | yes | no
8916
8917 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8918 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8919 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8920 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8921 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8922 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8923 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8924
8925 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8926
8927 See also : section 8 about logging.
8928
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008929
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008930option independent-streams
8931no option independent-streams
8932 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8934 yes | yes | yes | yes
8935 Arguments : none
8936
8937 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8938 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8939 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8940 receive data or not.
8941
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008942 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008943 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8944 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8945 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8946 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8947 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8948 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8949 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8950 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8951 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8952 socket buffers.
8953
8954 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8955 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8956 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8957 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8958 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8959
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008960 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008961
8962
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008963option ldap-check
8964 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 yes | no | yes | yes
8967 Arguments : none
8968
8969 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8970 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8971 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8972 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8973
8974 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8975 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8976
8977 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8978 configure it.
8979
8980 Example :
8981 option ldap-check
8982
8983 See also : "option httpchk"
8984
8985
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008986option external-check
8987 Use external processes for server health checks
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | no | yes | yes
8990
8991 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8992 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8993 command".
8994
8995 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8996
8997 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8998
8999
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009000option log-health-checks
9001no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009002 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 yes | no | yes | yes
9005 Arguments : none
9006
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009007 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9008 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9009 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009010
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009011 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9012 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9013 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9014 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9015 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9016
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009017 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009018 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009019
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009020 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9021 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9022 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009023
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009024
9025option log-separate-errors
9026no option log-separate-errors
9027 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | yes | yes | no
9030 Arguments : none
9031
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009032 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009033 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9034 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9035 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9036 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9037 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9038 provides very important information.
9039
9040 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9041 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9042 error logs.
9043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009044 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009045 logging.
9046
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009047
9048option logasap
9049no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009050 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 yes | yes | yes | no
9053 Arguments : none
9054
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009055 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9056 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9057 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9058 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9059
9060 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9061 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9062 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9063 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9064 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009065 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009066 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9067 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9068 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9069 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009070 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009072 Examples :
9073 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9074 mode http
9075 option httplog
9076 option logasap
9077 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9078
9079 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9080 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9081 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9082 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009084 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009085 logging.
9086
9087
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009088option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009089 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9091 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009092 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009093 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9094 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009095 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9096 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009097
9098 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9099 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009101 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009102 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9103 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9104 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009105
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009106 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9107 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9108 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009109
9110 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009111 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009112 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9113 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9114 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9115 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9116 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9117 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9118 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9119
9120 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9121 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009122
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009123 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009124
9125 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9126 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9127 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9128 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009129 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009130 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009131
9132 See also: "option httpchk"
9133
9134
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009135option nolinger
9136no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009137 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009138 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009140 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009142 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009143 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9144 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9145 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9146 connections.
9147
9148 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9149 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009150 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9151 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9152 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9153 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9154 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9155 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9156 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9157 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9158 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9159 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9160 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9161 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9162 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009163
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009164 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9165 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9166 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9167 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9168 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009169
9170 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9171 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009172 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009173 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009174 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009175
9176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9178
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009179 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9180 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009181
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009182option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9183 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9185 yes | yes | yes | yes
9186 Arguments :
9187 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9188 matching <network>
9189 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9190 header name.
9191
9192 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9193 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9194 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9195 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9196 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9197 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9198 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9199 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9200 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9201 possible that the client has already brought one.
9202
9203 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9204 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9205 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9206 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9207 header and requires different one.
9208
9209 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9210 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9211 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009212 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9213 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9214 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9215 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9216 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009217
9218 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9219 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9220 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9221 both are defined.
9222
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009223 Examples :
9224 # Original Destination address
9225 frontend www
9226 mode http
9227 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9228
9229 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9230 backend www
9231 mode http
9232 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9233
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009234 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009235
9236
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009237option persist
9238no option persist
9239 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009242 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009243
9244 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9245 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9246 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9247 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9248 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9249 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9250 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9251 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9252 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9253 redirected to another valid server.
9254
9255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9257
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009258 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009259
9260
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009261option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9262 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9264 yes | no | yes | yes
9265 Arguments :
9266 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9267 PostgreSQL server.
9268
9269 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9270 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9271 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9272 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9273
9274 See also: "option httpchk"
9275
9276
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009277option prefer-last-server
9278no option prefer-last-server
9279 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9281 yes | no | yes | yes
9282 Arguments : none
9283
9284 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009285 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009286 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9287 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009288 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009289 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009290 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009291 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9292 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009293 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009294 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009295 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9296 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9297 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009298 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9299 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9300 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009301
9302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9304
9305 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9306
9307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009308option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009309option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009310no option redispatch
9311 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9313 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009314 Arguments :
9315 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9316 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9317 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009318 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009319 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009320 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009321 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9322 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9323 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009325
9326 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9327 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9328 be able to access the service anymore.
9329
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009330 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9331 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009332
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009333 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9334 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9335 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9336 following order:
9337
9338 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9339
9340 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9341 list, or
9342
9343 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9344
9345 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9346 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9347
9348 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9349 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9350 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9351 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9352
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009353 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009354 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9355 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9359
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009360 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009361
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009362
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009363option redis-check
9364 Use redis health checks for server testing
9365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 yes | no | yes | yes
9367 Arguments : none
9368
9369 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9370 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9371 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9372 find the "+PONG" response message.
9373
9374 Example :
9375 option redis-check
9376
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009377 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009378
9379
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009380option smtpchk
9381option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9382 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009385 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009386 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009387 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009388 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9389
9390 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9391 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9392 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9393
9394 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9395 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9396 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9397 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9398 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9399 dead server.
9400
9401 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9402 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009403 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009404 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9405
9406 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9407 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9408 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9409 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009410 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009411
9412 Example :
9413 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9414
9415 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009418option socket-stats
9419no option socket-stats
9420
9421 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9423 yes | yes | yes | no
9424
9425 Arguments : none
9426
9427
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009428option splice-auto
9429no option splice-auto
9430 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9432 yes | yes | yes | yes
9433 Arguments : none
9434
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009435 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009436 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009438 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009439 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009440 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9441 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9442 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9443 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9444
9445 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9446 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9447 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9448 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9449 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9450 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9451 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9452 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9453 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9454 keyword.
9455
9456 Example :
9457 option splice-auto
9458
9459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9461
9462 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9463 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9464
9465
9466option splice-request
9467no option splice-request
9468 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9470 yes | yes | yes | yes
9471 Arguments : none
9472
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009473 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009474 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009475 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9476 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9477 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9478 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9479
9480 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9481
9482 Example :
9483 option splice-request
9484
9485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9487
9488 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9489 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9490
9491
9492option splice-response
9493no option splice-response
9494 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9496 yes | yes | yes | yes
9497 Arguments : none
9498
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009499 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009500 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009501 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9502 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9503 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9504 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9505
9506 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9507
9508 Example :
9509 option splice-response
9510
9511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9513
9514 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9515 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9516
9517
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009518option spop-check
9519 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9521 no | no | no | yes
9522 Arguments : none
9523
9524 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9525 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9526 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9527 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9528
9529 Example :
9530 option spop-check
9531
9532 See also : "option httpchk"
9533
9534
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009535option srvtcpka
9536no option srvtcpka
9537 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9539 yes | no | yes | yes
9540 Arguments : none
9541
9542 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9543 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009544 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009545 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9546
9547 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9548 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9549 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9550 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9551
9552 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9553 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9554 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9555 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9556 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9557
9558 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9559
9560 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9561 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9562 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9563
9564 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9565 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9566
9567 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9568
9569
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009570option ssl-hello-chk
9571 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9573 yes | no | yes | yes
9574 Arguments : none
9575
9576 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9577 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9578 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9579 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9580 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9581 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9582 hello message.
9583
9584 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9585 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9586 messages, which is appreciable.
9587
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009588 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009589 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9590 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009591
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009592 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9593
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009594
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009595option tcp-check
9596 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9598 yes | no | yes | yes
9599
9600 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9601 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9602
9603 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9604 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9605 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9606
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009607 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009608 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9609 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9610 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9611 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9612 only.
9613
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009614 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009615 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009616 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9617 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9618 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9619
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009620 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9622 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009623 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9625 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9626 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9627 the respective protocols.
9628 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009629 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009630
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009631 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009632
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009633 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9634 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9635 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9636 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009637
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009638 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9639 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9640 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009641
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009642
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009643 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009644 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009645 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009646 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009648 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009649 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009650 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009651
9652 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9653 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009654 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009655 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009656 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009657 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009658 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009659 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009660 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9661 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009662 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009663 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9664 tcp-check expect string +OK
9665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009666 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009667 (send many headers before analyzing)
9668 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009669 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009670 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9671 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9672 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9673 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009674 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009675
9676
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009677 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009678
9679
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009680option tcp-smart-accept
9681no option tcp-smart-accept
9682 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | yes | yes | no
9685 Arguments : none
9686
9687 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9688 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9689 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9690 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9691 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9692 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9693
9694 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9695 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9696 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9697 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9698
9699 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9700 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9701 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009702 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009703
9704 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9705 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9706 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9707
9708 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9709 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9710 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9711
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009712 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9713
9714
9715option tcp-smart-connect
9716no option tcp-smart-connect
9717 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 yes | no | yes | yes
9720 Arguments : none
9721
9722 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9723 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9724 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9725 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9726 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9727
9728 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9729 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9730 complex.
9731
9732 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9733 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9734 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9735
9736 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9737 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9738
9739 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9740
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009741
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009742option tcpka
9743 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9745 yes | yes | yes | yes
9746 Arguments : none
9747
9748 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9749 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009750 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009751 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9752
9753 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9754 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9755 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9756 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9757
9758 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9759 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9760 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9761 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9762 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9763
9764 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9765
9766 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9767 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9768 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9769 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9770 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9771 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9772 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9773 backends.
9774
9775 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9776
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009777
9778option tcplog
9779 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009781 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009782 Arguments : none
9783
9784 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9785 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9786 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9787 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9788 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9789 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9790 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9791 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9792
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009793 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009795 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009796
9797
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009798option transparent
9799no option transparent
9800 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009802 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009803 Arguments : none
9804
9805 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9806 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9807 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9808 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9809 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9810 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9811 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9812 appropriate server.
9813
9814 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9815 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9816
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009817 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009818 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009820
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009821external-check command <command>
9822 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 yes | no | yes | yes
9825
9826 Arguments :
9827 <command> is the external command to run
9828
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009829 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9830
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009831 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009832
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009833 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9834 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9835 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9836 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9837 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9838 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009839
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009840 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9841
9842 Environment variables :
9843 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9844 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9845
9846 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9847
9848 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9849
9850 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9851 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9852 for a UNIX socket).
9853
9854 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9855
9856 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9857
9858 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9859
9860 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9861
9862 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9863
9864 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9865 socket).
9866
9867 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9868 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9869
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009870 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9871
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009872 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9873 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9874 failed.
9875
9876 Example :
9877 external-check command /bin/true
9878
9879 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9880
9881
9882external-check path <path>
9883 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9885 yes | no | yes | yes
9886
9887 Arguments :
9888 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9889
9890 The default path is "".
9891
9892 Example :
9893 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9894
9895 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9896 "external-check command"
9897
9898
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009899persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009900persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009901 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9903 yes | no | yes | yes
9904 Arguments :
9905 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009906 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9907 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009908
9909 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9910 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009911 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009912 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9913 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9914 forwarded to this server.
9915
9916 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9917 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9918 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009919 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009920 a single "listen" section.
9921
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009922 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9923 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9924 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9925
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009926 Example :
9927 listen tse-farm
9928 bind :3389
9929 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9930 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9931 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9932 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9933 persist rdp-cookie
9934 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009935 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009936 balance rdp-cookie
9937 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9938 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9939
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009940 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9941 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009942
9943
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009944rate-limit sessions <rate>
9945 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 yes | yes | yes | no
9948 Arguments :
9949 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9950 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9951
9952 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9953 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9954 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009955 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009956 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9957 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9958
9959 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9960 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9961 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9962 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9963
9964 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9965 listen smtp
9966 mode tcp
9967 bind :25
9968 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009969 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009970
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009971 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9972 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9973 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009974
9975 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9976
9977
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009978redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9979redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9980redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009981 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9983 no | yes | yes | yes
9984
9985 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009986 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009987
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009988 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009989 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009990 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9991 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9992 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009993
9994 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9995 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9996 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9997 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9998 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009999 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10000 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10001 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10002 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010003
10004 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10005 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10006 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10007 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10008 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10009 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010010 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010011 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010012 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10013 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10014 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010015
10016 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010017 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10018 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10019 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010020 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010021 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10022 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10023 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10024 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010025
10026 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010027 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010028
10029 - "drop-query"
10030 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10031 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10032 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10033 with a location-type redirect.
10034
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010035 - "append-slash"
10036 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10037 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10038 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10039 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10040
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010041 - "ignore-empty"
10042 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10043 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10044 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10045 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10046 of known paths using a simple map.
10047
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010048 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10049 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10050 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10051 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10052 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10053 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10054 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10055
10056 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10057 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10058 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10059 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10060 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10061 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10062 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010063
10064 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10065 acl clear dst_port 80
10066 acl secure dst_port 8080
10067 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010068 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010069 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010070 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10071
10072 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010073 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10074 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10075 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010076 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010077
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010078 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10079 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10080 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010082 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010083 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010084
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010085 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010086 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10087 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10088 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010089
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010090 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10091 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10092 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010094 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010095
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010096
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010097retries <value>
10098 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10099 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10100 yes | no | yes | yes
10101 Arguments :
10102 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10103 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10104 default value is 3.
10105
10106 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10107 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10108 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10109
10110 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010111 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10112 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010113
10114 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10115 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10116
10117 See also : "option redispatch"
10118
10119
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010120retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010121 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10122 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10123 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010124 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10125 yes | no | yes | yes
10126 Arguments :
10127 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10128 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10129 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10130 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10131
10132 none never retry
10133
10134 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10135 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10136
10137 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10138 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10139 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10140 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10141 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10142 processing the request.
10143
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010144 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10145 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10146 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10147 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10148 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10149 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10150 overflow attack for example).
10151
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010152 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10153 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10154 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10155 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10156 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10157 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10158 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10159 amplify denial of service attacks.
10160
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010161 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10162 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10163 considered to be safe to retry.
10164
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010165 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10166 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10167 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10168 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10169 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010170
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010171 all-retryable-errors
10172 retry request for any error that are considered
10173 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10174 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10175 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10176
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010177 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10178 not cumulative.
10179
10180 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10181 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10182 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10183 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10184
10185 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10186 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10187 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10188 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10189 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10190 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10191 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10192 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10193 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10194 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10195 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10196 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10197
10198 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10199 should not use this directive.
10200
10201 The default is "conn-failure".
10202
10203 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10204
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010205server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010206 Declare a server in a backend
10207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10208 no | no | yes | yes
10209 Arguments :
10210 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010211 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010212 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010213
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010214 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10215 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10216 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10217 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010218 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10219 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010220 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010221 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10222 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010223 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10224 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10225 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10226 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10227 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10228 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10229 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010230 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010231 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10232 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10233 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10234 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10235 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10236 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010237 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10238 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010239 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10240 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010241
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010242 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010243 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10244 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10245 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10246 adding this value to the client's port.
10247
10248 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10249 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010250 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010251
10252 Examples :
10253 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10254 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010255 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010256 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10257 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10258 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010259
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010260 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10261 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10262 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10263 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10264 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10265
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010266 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10267 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010268
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010269server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010270 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010271 this backend.
10272 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10273 no | no | yes | yes
10274
10275 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10276 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10277 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10278 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10279 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010280
10281 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10282 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10283
10284 global
10285 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10286
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010287 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010288 load-server-state-from-file
10289
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010290 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010291 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010292
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010293server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10294 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10295 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 no | no | yes | yes
10298
10299 Arguments:
10300 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10301
10302 <num | range>
10303 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10304 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10305 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10306 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10307
10308 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10309
10310 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10311
10312 <params*>
10313 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10314 keyword.
10315
10316 Examples:
10317 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10318 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10319 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10320
10321 # or
10322 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10323
10324 # would be equivalent to:
10325 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10326 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10327 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10328
10329
10330
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010332source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010333source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010334 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10336 yes | no | yes | yes
10337 Arguments :
10338 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10339 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010340
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010342 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10343 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10344 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10345 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10346 supported prefixes are :
10347 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10348 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10349 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010350 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010351 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10352 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010353
10354 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10355 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010356 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10357 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10358 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010359
10360 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10361 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10362 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10363 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10364 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10365 <addr>.
10366
10367 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10368 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10369 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10370 port.
10371
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010372 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10373 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10374 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10375 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010376 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010377 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10378 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10379 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10380 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10381 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10382 HTTP header.
10383
10384 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10385 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010386 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010387 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10388 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10389 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10390 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10391 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10392 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10393 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10394
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010395 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10396 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10397 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10398 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10399 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10400 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10401
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010402 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10403 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10404 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10405 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10406
10407 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10408 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10409 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10410 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10411 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10412 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10413
10414 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10415 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10416 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10417 there are two methods :
10418
10419 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10420 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10421 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10422 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10423 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10424 of the client ranges may be used.
10425
10426 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10427 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10428 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10429 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10430 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10431 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10432 same session.
10433
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010434 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10435 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10436 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010437 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010439 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10440
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010441 Examples :
10442 backend private
10443 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10444 source 192.168.1.200
10445
10446 backend transparent_ssl1
10447 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10448 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10449
10450 backend transparent_ssl2
10451 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10452 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10453 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10454
10455 backend transparent_ssl3
10456 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10457 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10458 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10459
10460 backend transparent_smtp
10461 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10462 # with Tproxy version 4.
10463 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10464
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010465 backend transparent_http
10466 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10467 # proxy.
10468 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010470 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010471 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10472
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010473
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010474srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10475 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10476 the connection on the server side.
10477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10478 yes | no | yes | yes
10479 Arguments :
10480 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10481
10482 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10483 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010484 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10485 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010486
10487 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10488
10489
10490srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10491 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10492 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10493 server side.
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
10496 Arguments :
10497 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10498 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10499 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10500 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10501
10502 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10503 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010504 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10505 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010506
10507 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10508
10509
10510srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10511 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 yes | no | yes | yes
10514 Arguments :
10515 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10516 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10517 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10518 document.
10519
10520 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10521 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010522 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10523 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010524
10525 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10526
10527
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010528stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10529 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010531 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010532
10533 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10534 matched.
10535
10536 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10537 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10538
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010539 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10540 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10541 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10542 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010543
10544 Example :
10545 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10546 backend stats_localhost
10547 stats enable
10548 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10549
10550 Example :
10551 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10552 backend stats_auth
10553 stats enable
10554 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10555 stats admin if TRUE
10556
10557 Example :
10558 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10559 userlist stats-auth
10560 group admin users admin
10561 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10562 group readonly users haproxy
10563 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10564
10565 backend stats_auth
10566 stats enable
10567 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10568 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10569 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10570 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10571
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010572 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10573 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010574
10575
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010576stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10577 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010580 Arguments :
10581 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10582
10583 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10584
10585 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10586 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10587 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10588 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10589 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10590 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10591
10592 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10593 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10594 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010595 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010596
10597 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10598 report using "stats scope".
10599
10600 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10601 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10602 unobvious parameters.
10603
10604 Example :
10605 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10606 backend public_www
10607 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10608 stats enable
10609 stats hide-version
10610 stats scope .
10611 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010613 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10614 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10615
10616 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10617 backend private_monitoring
10618 stats enable
10619 stats uri /admin?stats
10620 stats refresh 5s
10621
10622 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10623
10624
10625stats enable
10626 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010628 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010629 Arguments : none
10630
10631 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10632 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10633 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10634 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10635 - stats auth : no authentication
10636 - stats scope : no restriction
10637
10638 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10639 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10640 unobvious parameters.
10641
10642 Example :
10643 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10644 backend public_www
10645 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10646 stats enable
10647 stats hide-version
10648 stats scope .
10649 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010651 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10652 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10653
10654 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10655 backend private_monitoring
10656 stats enable
10657 stats uri /admin?stats
10658 stats refresh 5s
10659
10660 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10661
10662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010663stats hide-version
10664 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010667 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010668
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010669 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10670 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10671 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10672 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10673 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10674 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010676 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10677 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10678 unobvious parameters.
10679
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010680 Example :
10681 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10682 backend public_www
10683 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010684 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010685 stats hide-version
10686 stats scope .
10687 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010688 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010689 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10690 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010691
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010692 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10693 backend private_monitoring
10694 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010695 stats uri /admin?stats
10696 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010697
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010698 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010699
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010700
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010701stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10702 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10703 Access control for statistics
10704
10705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10706 no | no | yes | yes
10707
10708 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10709 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10710 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10711 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10712 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10713 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10714
10715 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10716 instance.
10717
10718 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10719 about ACL usage.
10720
10721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010722stats realm <realm>
10723 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments :
10727 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10728 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10729 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10730
10731 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10732 using a backslash ('\').
10733
10734 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10735 only related to authentication.
10736
10737 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10738 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10739 unobvious parameters.
10740
10741 Example :
10742 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10743 backend public_www
10744 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10745 stats enable
10746 stats hide-version
10747 stats scope .
10748 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10751 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10752
10753 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10754 backend private_monitoring
10755 stats enable
10756 stats uri /admin?stats
10757 stats refresh 5s
10758
10759 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10760
10761
10762stats refresh <delay>
10763 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010765 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010766 Arguments :
10767 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10768 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10769 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10770 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10771 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10772 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10773
10774 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10775 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10776 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010777 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010778
10779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10781 unobvious parameters.
10782
10783 Example :
10784 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10785 backend public_www
10786 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10787 stats enable
10788 stats hide-version
10789 stats scope .
10790 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010792 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10793 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10794
10795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10796 backend private_monitoring
10797 stats enable
10798 stats uri /admin?stats
10799 stats refresh 5s
10800
10801 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10802
10803
10804stats scope { <name> | "." }
10805 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010808 Arguments :
10809 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10810 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10811 section in which the statement appears.
10812
10813 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10814 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10815 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10816 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10817 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10818 exists.
10819
10820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10822 unobvious parameters.
10823
10824 Example :
10825 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10826 backend public_www
10827 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10828 stats enable
10829 stats hide-version
10830 stats scope .
10831 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010832 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010833 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10834 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10835
10836 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10837 backend private_monitoring
10838 stats enable
10839 stats uri /admin?stats
10840 stats refresh 5s
10841
10842 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010844
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010845stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010846 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010849
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010850 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010851 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10852
10853 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10854 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10855
10856 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10857 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010858 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010859
10860 Example :
10861 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10862 backend private_monitoring
10863 stats enable
10864 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10865 stats uri /admin?stats
10866 stats refresh 5s
10867
10868 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10869 global section.
10870
10871
10872stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010873 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10875 yes | yes | yes | yes
10876 Arguments : none
10877
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010878 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010879 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10880 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10881 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10882 - IP (socket, server)
10883 - cookie (backend, server)
10884
10885 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10886 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010887 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010888
10889 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10890
10891
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010892stats show-modules
10893 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10895 yes | yes | yes | yes
10896 Arguments : none
10897
10898 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10899 values as a tooltip.
10900
10901 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10902 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10903 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10904
10905 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10906
10907
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010908stats show-node [ <name> ]
10909 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010911 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010912 Arguments:
10913 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10914 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10915
10916 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10917 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010919
10920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10922 unobvious parameters.
10923
10924 Example:
10925 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10926 backend private_monitoring
10927 stats enable
10928 stats show-node Europe-1
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
10930 stats refresh 5s
10931
10932 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10933 section.
10934
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010935
10936stats uri <prefix>
10937 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010939 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940 Arguments :
10941 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10942 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10943 query string.
10944
10945 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10946 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10947 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10948 possible to reach it in the application.
10949
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010950 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010951 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010952 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10953 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10954 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10955 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10956
10957 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10958 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10959 an address or a port to statistics only.
10960
10961 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10962 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10963 unobvious parameters.
10964
10965 Example :
10966 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10967 backend public_www
10968 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10969 stats enable
10970 stats hide-version
10971 stats scope .
10972 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010973 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010974 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10975 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10976
10977 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10978 backend private_monitoring
10979 stats enable
10980 stats uri /admin?stats
10981 stats refresh 5s
10982
10983 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10984
10985
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010986stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10987 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010989 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010990
10991 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010992 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010993 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010995 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10996
10997 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10998 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10999 the "stick-table" statement.
11000
11001 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11002 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11003 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11004 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11005 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11006
11007 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11008 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11009 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11010 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11011 transformation rules.
11012
11013 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11014 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11015 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11016 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11017 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11018 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11019 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11020
11021 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11022 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11023 ACL based conditions.
11024
11025 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11026 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11027 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11028 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11029
11030 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11031 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11032 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11033 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11034
11035 Example :
11036 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11037 # last 30 minutes
11038 backend pop
11039 mode tcp
11040 balance roundrobin
11041 stick store-request src
11042 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11043 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11044 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11045
11046 backend smtp
11047 mode tcp
11048 balance roundrobin
11049 stick match src table pop
11050 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11051 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11052
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011053 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11054 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011055
11056
11057stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11058 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11060 no | no | yes | yes
11061
11062 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11063 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11064 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11065 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11066
11067 Examples :
11068 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011069 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011070
11071 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11072 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11073 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11074
11075
11076 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11077 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11078 backend http
11079 mode http
11080 balance roundrobin
11081 stick on src table https
11082 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11083 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11084 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11085
11086 backend https
11087 mode tcp
11088 balance roundrobin
11089 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11090 stick on src
11091 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11092 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11093
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011094 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011095
11096
11097stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11098 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11100 no | no | yes | yes
11101
11102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011103 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011104 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011105 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011106 server is selected.
11107
11108 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11109 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11110 the "stick-table" statement.
11111
11112 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11113 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11114 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11115 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11116 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11117 address.
11118
11119 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11120 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11121 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11122 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11123 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11124 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11125 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11126 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11127 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11128 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11129
11130 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11131 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11132 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11133 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11134 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11135 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11136 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11137
11138 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11139 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11140 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11141 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11142
11143 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11144 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11145 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11146 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11147 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11148 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011149 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11150 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11151 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11152 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11153 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11154 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011155
11156 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11157 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11158 the request.
11159
11160 Example :
11161 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11162 # last 30 minutes
11163 backend pop
11164 mode tcp
11165 balance roundrobin
11166 stick store-request src
11167 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11168 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11169 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11170
11171 backend smtp
11172 mode tcp
11173 balance roundrobin
11174 stick match src table pop
11175 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11176 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11177
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011178 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011179
11180
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011181stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011182 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011183 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011184 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011186 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011187
11188 Arguments :
11189 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11190 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11191 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11192 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11193
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011194 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11195 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11196 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11197 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11198
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011199 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11200 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11201 instance.
11202
11203 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11204 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11205 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11206 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11207 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11208 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011209 to 32 characters.
11210
11211 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11212 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11213 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011214 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011215 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11216 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011217
11218 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011219 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11220 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11222 increase.
11223
11224 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011225 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11226 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11227 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228
11229 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011230 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011231 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11232 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011233 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011234 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11235 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11236 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11237 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11238 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11239 parameter (see below).
11240
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011241 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11242 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11243 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11244 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11245 soft restart.
11246
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011247 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11248 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11249 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11250 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011251 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011252 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011253 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11254 if not expiration delay is specified.
11255
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011256 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11257 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11258 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11259 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11260 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11261 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11262 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11263 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11264 token.
11265
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011266 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11267 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11268 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11269 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011270 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11271 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11272 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11273 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11274 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11275 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11276 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11277 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11278 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11279 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11280 types and their arguments.
11281
11282 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11283 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11284 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11285 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11286
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011287 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11288 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11289 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11290 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11291 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11292 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11293 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11294 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11295 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11296 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011297 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11298 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11299 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11300 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011301
11302 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11303 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11304 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11305 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11306 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11307 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11308 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11309 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11310 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11311 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11312 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11313 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011314 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11315 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11316 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11317 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011318
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011319 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11320 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11321 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011322 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011323
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011324 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11325 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11326 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011327 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011328 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011329 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011330
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011331 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11332 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11333 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11334 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11335
11336 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11337 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11338 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11339 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11340 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11341 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11342
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011343 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11344 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11345 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11346 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11347 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11348 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11349 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11350 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11351 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11352 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011353 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11354 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11355 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011356
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011357 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11358 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11359 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11360 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11361
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011362 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11363 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11364 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11365 they were received.
11366
11367 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11368 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11369 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11370 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11371 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11372
11373 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11374 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11375 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11376 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11377 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11378
11379 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11380 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11381 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11382
11383 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11384 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11385 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11386 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11387 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11388
11389 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11390 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11391 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11392 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11393 the client side.
11394
11395 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11396 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11397 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11398 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11399 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11400 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11401 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11402
11403 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11404 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11405 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11406 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11407 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11408 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011410
11411 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11412 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11413 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11414 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11415 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11416 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11417
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011418 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11419 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11420 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11421 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11422 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11423
11424 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11425 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11426 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11427 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11428 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11429 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11430
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011431 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011432 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011433 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11434 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11435
11436 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11437 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11438 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11439 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11440 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11441 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11442 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11443 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11444 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11445 recommended for better fairness.
11446
11447 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011448 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011449 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11450 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11451
11452 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11453 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11454 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11455 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11456 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11457 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11458 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11459 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11460 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11461 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011462
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011463 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11464 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011465 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11466 reference it.
11467
11468 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11469 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011470 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11471 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11472 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011473
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011474 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11475 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11476 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11477 something that can be ignored.
11478
11479 Example:
11480 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11481 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11482 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11483 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11484
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011485 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011486 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011487
11488
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011489stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011490 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11492 no | no | yes | yes
11493
11494 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011495 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011496 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011497 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011498 server is selected.
11499
11500 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11501 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11502 the "stick-table" statement.
11503
11504 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11505 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11506 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11507 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11508
11509 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11510 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11511 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11512 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11513 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11514 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011515 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011516 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11517 rules.
11518
11519 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11520 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11521 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11522 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11523 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11524 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11525 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11526
11527 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11528 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11529 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11530 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11531
11532 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11533 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11534 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11535 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11536 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11537 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011538 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11539 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11540 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11541 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11542 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11543 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11544 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11545 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11546 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011547
11548 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11549
11550 Example :
11551 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11552 backend https
11553 mode tcp
11554 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011555 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011556 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011557
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011558 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11559 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11560
11561 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11562 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11563 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11564
11565 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11566 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011567
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011568 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11569 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11570 # at offset 44.
11571
11572 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11573 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11574
11575 # Learn on response if server hello.
11576 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011577
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011578 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11579 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11580
11581 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11582 extraction.
11583
11584
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011585tcp-check comment <string>
11586 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11587 it fails.
11588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11589 yes | no | yes | yes
11590
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011591 Arguments :
11592 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11593 rule fails.
11594
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011595 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11596 user-friendly error reporting.
11597
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011598 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11599 "tcp-check expect".
11600
11601
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011602tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11603 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011604 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011605 Opens a new connection
11606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011607 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011608
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011609 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011610 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11611
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011612 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011613 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011614
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011615 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011616 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11617 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011618 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011619
11620 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011621
11622 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11623
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011624 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11625
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011626 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11627
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011628 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11629
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011630 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11631 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11632 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11633 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11634
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011635 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11636 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11637 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11638 haproxy -vv.
11639
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011640 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011641
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011642 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11643 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11644 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11645
11646 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11647 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11648 of the sequence.
11649
11650 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11651 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11652 do.
11653
11654 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11655 unset-var or comment rules.
11656
11657 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011658 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11659 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11660 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11661 option tcp-check
11662 tcp-check connect
11663 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11664 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11665 tcp-check send \r\n
11666 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11667 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11668 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11669 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11670 tcp-check send \r\n
11671 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11672 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11673
11674 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11675 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011676 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011677 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11678 tcp-check connect port 143
11679 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11680 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11681
11682 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11683
11684
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011685tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011686 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011687 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011688 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011689 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011691 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011692
11693 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011694 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11695
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011696 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11697 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11698 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11699 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11700 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11701 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11702 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11703 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11704 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11705 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11706
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011707 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011708 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11709 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011710 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11711 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11712 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11713
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011714 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11715 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11716 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011717 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11718 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011719 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11720 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011721 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11722 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011723 By default "L7OK" is used.
11724
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011725 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11726 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011727 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11728 supported :
11729 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11730 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011731 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11732 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11733 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11734 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11735 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011736
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011737 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011738 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011739 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11740 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11741 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11742 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011743 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11744
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011745 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11746 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11747 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11748 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11749
11750 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11751 informational message reported in logs if an error
11752 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11753 log-format string.
11754
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011755 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11756 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11757 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11758 followed by some converters.
11759
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011760 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11761 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11762 with the usual backslash ('\').
11763 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011765 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11766 used upper or lower case.
11767
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011768 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11769
11770 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11771 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11772 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11773 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11774 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11775 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11776 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11777 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11778
11779 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11780 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11781 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11782 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11783 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11784 expression.
11785
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011786 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11787 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11788 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11789 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11790 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11791 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11792
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011793 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11794 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11795 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11796 this exact hexadecimal string.
11797 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11798
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011799 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11800 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11801 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11802 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11803 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11804 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11805 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11806 size.
11807
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011808 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11809 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11810 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11811 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11812 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11813 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11814 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11815 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11816 in a binary string before matching the response's
11817 buffer.
11818
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011819 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011820 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011821 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11822 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11823 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11824 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11825 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11826 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11827 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11828 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11829 the null character.
11830
11831 Examples :
11832 # perform a POP check
11833 option tcp-check
11834 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11835
11836 # perform an IMAP check
11837 option tcp-check
11838 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11839
11840 # look for the redis master server
11841 option tcp-check
11842 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011843 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011844 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11845 tcp-check expect string role:master
11846 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11847 tcp-check expect string +OK
11848
11849
11850 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011851 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011852
11853
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011854tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11855tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11856 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11857 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011859 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011860
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011861 Arguments :
11862 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11863
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011864 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11865 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011866
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011867 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11868 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011869
11870 Examples :
11871 # look for the redis master server
11872 option tcp-check
11873 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11874 tcp-check expect string role:master
11875
11876 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011877 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011878
11879
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011880tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11881tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11882 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11883 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011885 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011886
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011887 Arguments :
11888 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011889
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011890 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11891 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011892
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011893 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11894 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11895 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011896
11897 Examples :
11898 # redis check in binary
11899 option tcp-check
11900 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11901 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11902
11903
11904 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011905 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011906
11907
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011908tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011909tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011910 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011912 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011913
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011914 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011915 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11916 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11917 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11918 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11919 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11920 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11921 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11922 and '-'.
11923
11924 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11925
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011926 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
11927 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
11928
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011929 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011930 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011931 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011932
11933
11934tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011935 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011937 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011938
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011939 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011940 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11941 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11942 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11943 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11944 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11946 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11947 and '-'.
11948
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011949 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011950 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11951
11952
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020011953tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011954 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020011956 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011957 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011958 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11959 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011961 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011962
11963 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11964 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011965 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11966 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11967 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11968 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11969 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11970 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011972 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11973 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11974 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020011975 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
11976 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
11977 is true.
11978
11979 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
11980 supported:
11981 - accept
11982 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
11983 - expect-proxy layer4
11984 - reject
11985 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
11986 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
11987 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
11988 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11990 - set-dst <expr>
11991 - set-dst-port <expr>
11992 - set-mark <mark>
11993 - set-src <expr>
11994 - set-src-port <expr>
11995 - set-tos <tos>
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010011996 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11997 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020011998 - silent-drop
11999 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12000 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12001 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012002 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012003
12004 The supported actions are described below.
12005
12006 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12007 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012008
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012009 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12010 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12011 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12012 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12013 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12014 a defaults section defining such rules.
12015
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012016 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12017 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12018 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012019
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012020 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12021 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12022 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012023
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012024 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12025 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12026 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012027
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012028 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12029 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12030 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012031
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012032 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12033 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12034 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012035
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012036 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012037
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012038 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012039
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012041
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012042 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012043
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012044tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012045
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012046 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12047 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012048
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012049tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012052 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12053 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12054 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12055 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12056 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12057 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12058 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012059
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012060tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012061
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012062 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12063 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12064 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12065 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12066 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12067 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012068
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012069tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012070
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012071 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12072 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12073 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12074 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12075 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12076 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12077 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12078 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12079 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12080 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12081 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012082
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012083tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12084tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12085tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012086
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012087 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12088 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12089 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12090 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012091
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012092tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12093 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12094tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12095 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012096
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012097 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12098 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12099 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012100
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012101tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12102tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012104 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12105 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12106 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012107
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012108tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012109
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012110 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12111 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12112 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012114tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12115tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012116
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012117 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12118 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12119 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012120
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012121tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012122
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012123 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12124 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12125 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012126
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012127tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12128tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12129
12130 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12131 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12132 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12133 for a complete description.
12134
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012135tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012136
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012137 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12138 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12139 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12140 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012141
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012142tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12143tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12144tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012145
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012146 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12147 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12148 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012149
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012150tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12151
12152 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12153 details about variables.
12154
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012156tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12157 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012159 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012160 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012161 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12162 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012164 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012165
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012166 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012167 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12168 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012169 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12170 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12173 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12174 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12175 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012176 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012177 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012178 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12179 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12180 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12181 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012182 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012183 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012185 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12186 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12187 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12188 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012189
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012190 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12191 supported:
12192 - accept
12193 - capture <sample> len <length>
12194 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12195 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012196 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012197 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012198 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012199 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012200 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012201 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012202 - set-dst <expr>
12203 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012204 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012205 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012206 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012207 - set-priority-class <expr>
12208 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012209 - set-src <expr>
12210 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012211 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012212 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012213 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012214 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012215 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012216 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12217 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12218 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012219 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012220 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012221
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012222 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012223
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012224 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12225 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12226 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12227 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12228 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12229 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012230
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012231 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12232 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12233 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12234 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12235 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12236 a defaults section defining such rules.
12237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012238 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012239 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12240 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012241
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012242 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12243 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12244 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12245 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12246 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12247 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012249 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012250 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12251 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12252 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12253 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12254 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12255 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12256 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12257 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12258 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12259 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012260
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012261 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012262 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12263 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12264 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012265
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012266 Example:
12267 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12268
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012269 Example:
12270
12271 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012272 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012273 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012274
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012275 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012276 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012277 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012278 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12279 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012280 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012281 tcp-request content reject
12282
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012283 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12284 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12285 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12286 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12287 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12288 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12289 ...
12290 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012292 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012293 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12294 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12295 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012296 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012297
12298 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12299 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12300 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012301 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012302 tcp-request content reject
12303
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012304 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012305 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012306 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012307 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012308 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12309 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012310
12311 Example:
12312 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12313 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012314 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012316 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012317 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012318
12319 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012320 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012321 # protecting all our sites
12322 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012323 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12324 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012325 ...
12326 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12327
12328 backend http_dynamic
12329 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012330 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012331 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012332 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012333 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012334 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012335 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012337 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012338
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012339 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12340 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012341
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012342tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12343
12344 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012345 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012346
12347tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12348 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12349
12350 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12351 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12352 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12353 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12354 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12355 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12356 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12357 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12358 information.
12359
12360tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12361
12362 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12363 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12364 complete description.
12365
12366tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12367
12368 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12369 are evaluated.
12370
12371tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12372tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12373tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12374
12375 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12376 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12377 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12378 description.
12379
12380tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12382tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12384
12385 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12386 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12387 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12388
12389tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12390 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12391
12392 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12393 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12394
12395tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12396tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12397
12398 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12399 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12400 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12401
12402tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12403
12404 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12405 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12406
12407tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12408
12409 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12410 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12411 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12412
12413tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12414
12415 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12416 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12417
12418tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12419
12420 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12421 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12422
12423tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12424
12425 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12426 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12427 description.
12428
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012429tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12430tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12431
12432 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12433 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12434 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12435
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012436tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12437
12438 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12439 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12440 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12441
12442tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12443tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12444
12445 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12446 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12447 for a complete description.
12448
12449tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12450
12451 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12452 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12453 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12454 complete description.
12455
12456tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12457 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12458
12459 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12460 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12461 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12462 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12463 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12464 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12465 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12466 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12467 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12468 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12469
12470 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12471
12472tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12473tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12474tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12475
12476 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12477 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12478 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12479
12480tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12481
12482 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12483 details about variables.
12484
12485tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12486
12487 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12488 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12489 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12490 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12491 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12492
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012493
12494tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12495 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012497 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012498 Arguments :
12499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12501 as explained at the top of this document.
12502
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012503 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012504 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12505 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12506 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12507 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12508
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012509 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12510 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12511 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12512 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12513
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012514 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012515 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012516 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012517 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012518 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012519 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12520 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12521 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012522
12523 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12524 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12525 it pass through unaffected.
12526
12527 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12528 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12529 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012530 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012531 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12532 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012533 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12534 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12535 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012536
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012537 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12538 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12539
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012540 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012541 "timeout client".
12542
12543
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012544tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12545 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012547 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012548 Arguments :
12549 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12550 below.
12551
12552 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12553
12554 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12555 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12556 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12557 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012558 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012559 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12560 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12561 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12562 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12563 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12564 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12565 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12566 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12567 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12568 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12569 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12570 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12571 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12572 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12573 instead.
12574
12575 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12576 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12577 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12578 rules which may be inserted.
12579
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012580 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12581 supported:
12582 - accept
12583 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012584 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12585 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12586 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12587 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12588 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012589 - set-dst <expr>
12590 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012591 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012592 - set-src <expr>
12593 - set-src-port <expr>
12594 - set-tos <tos>
12595 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12596 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012597 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012598 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12599 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12600 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12601 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012602
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012603 The supported actions are described below.
12604
12605 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12606 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12607 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12608 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12609 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12610 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012611
12612 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12613 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12614 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12615
12616 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12617 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12618 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12619 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12620 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12621
12622 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12623 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12624
12625 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12626 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12627 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12628
12629 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12630 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12631 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12632
12633 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12634 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12635 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12636
12637 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12638 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12639 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12640
12641 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12642
12643 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12644
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012645tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12646
12647 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12648 rules are evaluated.
12649
12650tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12651
12652 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12653 are evaluated.
12654
12655tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12656tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12657tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12658
12659 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12660 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12661 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12662 description.
12663
12664tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12665 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12666tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12667 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12668
12669 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12670 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12671 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12672 description.
12673
12674tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12675tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12676
12677 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12678 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12679 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12680
12681tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12682
12683 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12684 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12685 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12686
12687tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12688tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12689
12690 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12691 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12692 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12693
12694tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12695
12696 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12697 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12698 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12699
12700tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12701tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12702
12703 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12704 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12705 for a complete description.
12706
12707tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12708
12709 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12710 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12711 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12712 complete description.
12713
12714tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12715tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12716tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12717
12718 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12719 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12720 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12721
12722tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12723
12724 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12725 details about variables.
12726
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012727
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012728tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12729 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012731 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012732 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012733 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12734 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012735
12736 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12737
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012738 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012739 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12740 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012741 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12742 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012743
12744 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12745
12746 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12747 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12748 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12749 inserted.
12750
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012751 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12752 supported:
12753 - accept
12754 - close
12755 - reject
12756 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12757 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12758 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12759 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12760 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12761 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12762 - set-log-level <level>
12763 - set-mark <mark>
12764 - set-nice <nice>
12765 - set-tos <tos>
12766 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12767 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
12768 - silent-drop
12769 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12770
12771 The supported actions are described below.
12772
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012773 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12774 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12775 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12776 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12777 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12778 a defaults section defining such rules.
12779
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012780 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12781 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12782 for changing the default action to a reject.
12783
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012784 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012785
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012786 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12787 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12788 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12789 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
12790 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012792 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012794 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012795
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012796tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012797
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012798 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12799 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012800
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012801tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012802
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012803 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
12804 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
12805 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
12806 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
12807 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
12808 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012809
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012810tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012811
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012812 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12813 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012814
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012815tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12816tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12817tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012818
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012819 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12820 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12821 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12822 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012823
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012824tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12825 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12826tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012828
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012829 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12830 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12831 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012832
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012833tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12834 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012836 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12837 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012838
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012839tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012840
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012841 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12842 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012843
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012844tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012845
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012846 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12847 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12848 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012849
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012850tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012851
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012852 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12853 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012854
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012855tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012856
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012857 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12858 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12859 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012860
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012861tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12862tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012863
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012864 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12865 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12866 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012867
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012868tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012869
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012870 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12871 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12872 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12873 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012874
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012875tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012876
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012877 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12878 details about variables.
12879
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012880
12881tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12882 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012884 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012885 Arguments :
12886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12888 as explained at the top of this document.
12889
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012890 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12891 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012892
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012893 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12894
12895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012896timeout check <timeout>
12897 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12898 established.
12899
12900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12901 yes | no | yes | yes
12902 Arguments:
12903 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12904 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12905 as explained at the top of this document.
12906
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012907 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012908 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012909 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012910 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012911 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12912 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12913 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012915 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012916 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12917
12918 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12919 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012920 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012921
12922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12924 forget about it.
12925
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012926 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12927 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12928
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012929 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12930 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012931
12932
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012933timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012934 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12936 yes | yes | yes | no
12937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012938 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012939 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12940 as explained at the top of this document.
12941
12942 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12943 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12944 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012945 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12946 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12947 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12948 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012949 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12950 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12951 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012952 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012953 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012954 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12955 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012956 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12957 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012958
12959 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12960 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12961 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12962 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012963 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012964 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12965
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012966 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012967
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012968 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012970
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012971timeout client-fin <timeout>
12972 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12974 yes | yes | yes | no
12975 Arguments :
12976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12978 as explained at the top of this document.
12979
12980 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12981 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12982 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12983 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12984 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12985 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12986 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012987 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12988 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12989 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012990
12991 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12992 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12993 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12994
12995 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12996
12997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012998timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012999 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13001 yes | no | yes | yes
13002 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13005 as explained at the top of this document.
13006
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013007 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013008 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013009 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013010 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013011 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13012 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013013
13014 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13015 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13016 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13017 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013018 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013019 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13020
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013021 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013023
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013024timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13025 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13027 yes | yes | yes | yes
13028 Arguments :
13029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13031 as explained at the top of this document.
13032
13033 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13034 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13035 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13036 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13037 once the request has started to present itself.
13038
13039 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13040 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13041 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13042 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13043 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13044
13045 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13046 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13047 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13048 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13049
13050 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13051 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013052 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013053 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13054 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013055 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013056
13057 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13058 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13059 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13060 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13061
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013062 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13063 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013064 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13065
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013066 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13067
13068
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013069timeout http-request <timeout>
13070 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13076 as explained at the top of this document.
13077
13078 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13079 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13080 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13081 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13082 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13083 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13084 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013085 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13086 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13087 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13088 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013089 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013090 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13091 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013092
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013093 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13094 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13095 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13096 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13097 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013098 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013099
13100 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13101 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013102 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013103 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13104 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13105
13106 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013107 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13108 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13109 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013110
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013111 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013112 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013114
13115timeout queue <timeout>
13116 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13118 yes | no | yes | yes
13119 Arguments :
13120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13122 as explained at the top of this document.
13123
13124 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13125 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13126 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13127 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13128 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13129
13130 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13131 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13132 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13133 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13134
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013135 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013136
13137
13138timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013139 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13141 yes | no | yes | yes
13142 Arguments :
13143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13145 as explained at the top of this document.
13146
13147 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13148 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13149 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13150 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13151 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13152 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13153 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13154
13155 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13156 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13157 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13158 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13159 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013160 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013161 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013162 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13163 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013164 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13165 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013166
13167 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13168 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13169 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13170 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013171 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013172 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13173
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013174 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013175
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013176
13177timeout server-fin <timeout>
13178 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13180 yes | no | yes | yes
13181 Arguments :
13182 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13183 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13184 as explained at the top of this document.
13185
13186 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13187 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13188 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13189 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13190 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13191 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13192 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13193 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13194 situations, it should not be needed.
13195
13196 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13197 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13198 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13199
13200 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013202
13203timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013204 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13206 yes | yes | yes | yes
13207 Arguments :
13208 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13210 as explained at the top of this document.
13211
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013212 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13213 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13214 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013215
13216 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13217 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13218 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13219 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013220 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013221
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013222 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013223
13224
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013225timeout tunnel <timeout>
13226 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13228 yes | no | yes | yes
13229 Arguments :
13230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13232 as explained at the top of this document.
13233
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013234 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013235 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13236 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13237 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013238 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13239 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013240 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13241 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13242 specified.
13243
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013244 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13245 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13246 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13247 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13248 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13249 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13250 state.
13251
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013252 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13253 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13254 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13255 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013256 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013257
13258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13260 forget about it.
13261
13262 Example :
13263 defaults http
13264 option http-server-close
13265 timeout connect 5s
13266 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013267 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013268 timeout server 30s
13269 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13270
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013271 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013272
13273
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013274transparent (deprecated)
13275 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013277 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013278 Arguments : none
13279
13280 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13281 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13282 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13283 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13284 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13285 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13286 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13287 appropriate server.
13288
13289 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13290
13291 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13292 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13293
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013294 See also: "option transparent"
13295
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013296unique-id-format <string>
13297 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13299 yes | yes | yes | no
13300 Arguments :
13301 <string> is a log-format string.
13302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013303 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13304 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13305 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13306 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013307
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013308 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013309 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013310 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13311 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13312 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13313 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13314 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13315 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013316
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013317 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13318 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013319
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013320 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013321
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013322 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013323
13324 will generate:
13325
13326 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13327
13328 See also: "unique-id-header"
13329
13330unique-id-header <name>
13331 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13333 yes | yes | yes | no
13334 Arguments :
13335 <name> is the name of the header.
13336
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013337 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13338 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013339
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013340 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013341
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013342 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013343 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13344
13345 will generate:
13346
13347 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13348
13349 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013350
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013351use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013352 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13354 no | yes | yes | no
13355 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013356 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13357 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013358
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013359 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13360 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013361
13362 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13363 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13364 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013365 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013366 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013367 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13368 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013369
13370 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13371 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13372 assign the backend.
13373
13374 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13375 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13376 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13377 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13378 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13379 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13380
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013381 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013382 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013383 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13384 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13385 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13386
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013387 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13388 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13389 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13390 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13391 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13392 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13393 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13394 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13395 cannot be forced from the request.
13396
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013397 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013398 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13399 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13400
13401 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13402 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013403
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013404use-fcgi-app <name>
13405 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13407 no | no | yes | yes
13408 Arguments :
13409 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13410
13411 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013412
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013413use-server <server> if <condition>
13414use-server <server> unless <condition>
13415 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13417 no | no | yes | yes
13418 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013419 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13420 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013421
13422 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13423
13424 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13425 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13426 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13427
13428 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13429 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13430 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13431 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13432 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13433 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13434 matches will assign the server.
13435
13436 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13437 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13438 with the next rules until one matches.
13439
13440 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13441 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13442 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13443 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13444
13445 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13446 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13447 stripped.
13448
13449 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13450 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013451 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013452 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013453 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013454
13455 Example :
13456 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013457 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013458 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013459 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013460 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013461 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013462 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013463 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13464 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13465
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013466 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13467 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13468 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13469 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013470 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013471 and we fall back to load balancing.
13472
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013473 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134765. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013477--------------------------
13478
13479The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13480depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13481settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13482written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13483described in this section.
13484
13485
134865.1. Bind options
13487-----------------
13488
13489The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13490as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13491no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13492parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13493while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13494provided immediately after the setting name.
13495
13496The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13497
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013498accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13499 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13500 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13501 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13502 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13503 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13504 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13505 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13506 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13507 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013508 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13509 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13510 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013511
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013512accept-proxy
13513 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013514 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13515 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013516 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13517 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13518 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13519 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013520 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013521 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13522 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013523 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13524 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013525
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013526allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013527 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013528 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013529 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013530 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13531 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013532
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013533alpn <protocols>
13534 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13535 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13536 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013537 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013538 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013539 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13540 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13541 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13542 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13543 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13544 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13545 preference, like below :
13546
13547 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013548
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013549backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013550 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013551 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13552
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013553curves <curves>
13554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13555 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13556 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13557 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13558 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13559 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13560
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013561ecdhe <named curve>
13562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013563 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13564 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013565
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013566ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13568 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13569 client's certificate.
13570
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013571ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13573 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13574 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13575 error is ignored.
13576
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013577ca-sign-file <cafile>
13578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13579 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13580 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13581 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13582 'generate-certificates' for details.
13583
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013584ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13586 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13587 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13588 'generate-certificates' for details.
13589
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013590ca-verify-file <cafile>
13591 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13592 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13593 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13594 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13595 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13596
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013597ciphers <ciphers>
13598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13599 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013600 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013601 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013602 information and recommendations see e.g.
13603 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13604 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13605 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13606
13607ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13609 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13610 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13611 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013612 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13613 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013614
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013615crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013616 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13617 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013618 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13619 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013620
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013621crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13623 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13624 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13625 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13626 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013627 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13628 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013629
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013630 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13631 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13632
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013633 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13634 are loaded.
13635
13636 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013637 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13638 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13639 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13640 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13641 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13642 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13643 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013644 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013645
13646 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13647 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13648 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13649 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013650 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13651 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013652
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013653 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013654
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013656 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13658 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013659 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13660 clients).
13661
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013662 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013663 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13664 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13665 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13666 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13667 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13668 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13669 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13670 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13671 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13672 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13673 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13674 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13675
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013676 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013677 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13678 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13679 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13680 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13681
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013682 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13683 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13684 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13685 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013686
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013687 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13688 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13689 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013690
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013691crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013694 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013695 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013696
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013697crt-list <file>
13698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013699 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13700 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013701
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013702 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13703
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013704 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13705 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13706 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13707 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13708 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013709
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013710 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013711 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13712 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13713 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13714 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13715 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013716 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13717 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13718 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013719
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013720 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13721 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13722 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013723
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013724 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13725
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013726 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013727 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013728 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13729 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13730 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13731 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13732 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13733 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013734
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013735 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013736 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013737 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013738 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013739 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013740 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013742defer-accept
13743 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13744 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13745 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013747 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13748 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13749 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13750 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13751 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13752 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13753 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13754
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013755expose-fd listeners
13756 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13757 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013758 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13759 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013760 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013761
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013762force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013763 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013764 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013765 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013766 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013767
13768force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013769 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013770 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013771 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013772
13773force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013774 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013775 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013776 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013777
13778force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013779 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013780 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013781 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013782
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013783force-tlsv13
13784 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13785 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013786 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013787
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013788generate-certificates
13789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13790 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13791 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13792 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13793 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13794 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13795 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13796 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13797 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13798 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13799 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13800
13801 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13802 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013803 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013804 certificate is used many times.
13805
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013806gid <gid>
13807 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13808 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13809 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13810 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13811 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13812
13813group <group>
13814 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13815 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13816 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13817 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13818 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13819
13820id <id>
13821 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13822 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13823 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13824 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13825
13826interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013827 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13828 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13829 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13830 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13831 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13832 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013833 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13834 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13835 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13836 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13837 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13838 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013839
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013840level <level>
13841 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13842 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13843 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013844 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013845 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13846 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13847 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013848 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013849 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013850 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013851 all counters).
13852
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013853severity-output <format>
13854 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13855 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13856 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13857 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13858 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13859 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13860 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13861 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13862 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13863 rfc5424 convention.
13864
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013865maxconn <maxconn>
13866 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13867 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13868 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13869 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13870 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13871 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13872 eat all memory.
13873
13874mode <mode>
13875 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13876 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13877 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13878 UNIX sockets.
13879
13880mss <maxseg>
13881 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13882 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13883 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13884 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13885 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13886 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13887 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13888 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13889 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13890 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13891 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13892
13893name <name>
13894 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13895 page.
13896
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013897namespace <name>
13898 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13899 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13900 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13901 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13902
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013903nice <nice>
13904 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13905 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13906 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13907 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13908 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13909 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13910 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13911 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13912 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13913 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13914 one for an RDP socket.
13915
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013916no-ca-names
13917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13918 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013919 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013920
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013921no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013923 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013924 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013925 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013926 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13927 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013928
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013929no-tls-tickets
13930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13931 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13932 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013933 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13934 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013935 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13936 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13937 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013938
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013939no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013941 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013942 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013943 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013944 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13945 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013947no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013949 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013950 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013951 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013952 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13953 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013955no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013957 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013958 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013959 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013960 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13961 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013962
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013963no-tlsv13
13964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13965 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13966 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13967 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013968 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13969 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013970
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013971npn <protocols>
13972 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13973 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13974 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013975 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013976 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013977 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13978 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13979 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13980 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13981 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013982
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013983prefer-client-ciphers
13984 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13985 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13986 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013987 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13988 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13989 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013990
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013991process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013992 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13993 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13994 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13995 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13996 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13997 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013998
13999 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14000
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014001 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014002 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14003 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14004 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14005 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14006 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014007
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014008 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14009 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14010
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014011proto <name>
14012 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14013 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14014 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014015 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14016 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14017
14018 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14019 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14020 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14021 also reported (flag=HTX).
14022
14023 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14024 a bind line :
14025
14026 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14027 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14028 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14029
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014030 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014031 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014032 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014033 h2" on the bind line.
14034
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014035shards <number> | by-thread
14036 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14037 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14038 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14039 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14040 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14041 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14042 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14043 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14044 little bit.
14045
14046 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14047 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14048 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14049 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14050 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14051 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014053ssl
14054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014055 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014056 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14057 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014058 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14059 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014060
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014061ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14062 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014063 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14064 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14065 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014066 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14067
14068ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014069 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14070 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14071 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14072 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014073
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014074strict-sni
14075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14076 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14077 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14078 See the "crt" option for more information.
14079
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014080tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014081 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014082 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014083 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014085 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14086 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14087 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14088 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14089 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14090 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14091 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14092
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014093tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014094 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014095 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14096 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14097 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14098 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14099 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14100 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14101 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014102 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14103 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14104 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014105
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014106thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014107 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14108 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14109 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014110
14111 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14112 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14113 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14114 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14115 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14116 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14117 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14118 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14119 of the parsing.
14120
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014121 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014122 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14123 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014124
14125 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14126
14127 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14128 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14129 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14130 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14131 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14132 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14133
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014134tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14135 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014136 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14137 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14138 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14139 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14140 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14141 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14142 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14143 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14144 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14145 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014146 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14147 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14148
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014149transparent
14150 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14151 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14152 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14153 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14154 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14155 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14156 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14157 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14158 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14159 so check for support with your vendor.
14160
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014161v4v6
14162 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14163 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14164 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14165 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014166 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014167
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014168v6only
14169 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14170 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14171 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014172 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14173 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014174
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014175uid <uid>
14176 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14177 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14178 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14179 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14180 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14181
14182user <user>
14183 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14184 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14185 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14186 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14187 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14188
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014189verify [none|optional|required]
14190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14191 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14192 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14193 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14194 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014195 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14196 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14197 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14198 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014199
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200142005.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014201------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014203The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14204which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14205arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14206settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14207after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14208Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14209address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014211 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014212 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014213
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014214Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14215keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014217The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014218
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014219addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014220 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014221 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14222 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14223 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14224 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14225 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014226
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014227agent-check
14228 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014229 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014230 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14231 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14232 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014233
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014234 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014235 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014236 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014237 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14238 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014239
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014240 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14241 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14242 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14243 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14244 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014245
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014246 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014247 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014248
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014249 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14250 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14251 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014252
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014253 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14254 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14255 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014256
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014257 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014258 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14259 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14260 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14261 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014262 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014263 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014264
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014265 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14266 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014267
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014268 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14269 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14270 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14271 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14272 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14273 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14274 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14275 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14276 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014277
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014278 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14279 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014280 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14281 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14282 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014283 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014284
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014285 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014286 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014287
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014288agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014289 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014290 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14291 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14292 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14293 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14294
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014295agent-inter <delay>
14296 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14297 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14298
14299 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14300 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14301 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14302 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14303 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14304 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14305 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14306 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14307 of backends use the same servers.
14308
14309 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14310
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014311agent-addr <addr>
14312 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14313
14314 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014315 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014316 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14317 hostname, it will be resolved.
14318
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014319agent-port <port>
14320 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14321
14322 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14323
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014324allow-0rtt
14325 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014326 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14327 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014328
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014329alpn <protocols>
14330 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14331 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14332 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014333 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014334 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14335 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14336 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14337 now obsolete NPN extension.
14338 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14339 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14340
14341 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14342
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014343 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014345backup
14346 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14347 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14348 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14349 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014350 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14351 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014352
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014353ca-file <cafile>
14354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14355 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14356 server's certificate.
14357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014358check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014359 This option enables health checks on a server:
14360 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14361 considered available.
14362 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14363 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14364 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14365 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14366 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14367 set.
14368 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14369 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14370 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14371 exchanges succeed.
14372
14373 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14374 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14375 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14376 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14377 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014378 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014379 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14380
14381 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14382 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14383
14384 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14385 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14386
14387 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14388 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14389 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14390 available.
14391
14392 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14393 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14394 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14395
14396 Example:
14397 # simple tcp check
14398 backend foo
14399 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14400 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14401 backend foo
14402 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14403 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14404 backend foo
14405 option tcp-check
14406 tcp-check connect
14407 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014408
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014409check-send-proxy
14410 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14411 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14412 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14413 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14414 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14415 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14416 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14417
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014418check-alpn <protocols>
14419 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14420 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14421 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14422
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014423check-proto <name>
14424 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14425 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14426 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014427 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14428 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14429
14430 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14431 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14432 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14433 also reported (flag=HTX).
14434
14435 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14436 directive on a server line:
14437
14438 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14439 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14440 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14441 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14442
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014443 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014444 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14445 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14446
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014447check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014448 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014449 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14450 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014451
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014452check-ssl
14453 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14454 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14455 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14456 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014457 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014458 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14459 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014460 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014461 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14462 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014463
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014464check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014465 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014466 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14467 for normal traffic.
14468
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014469ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14471 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14472 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014473 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14474 information and recommendations see e.g.
14475 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14476 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14477 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014478
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014479ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14481 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14482 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14483 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014484 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14485 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14486 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014488cookie <value>
14489 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14490 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14491 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14492 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14493 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14494 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14495 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14496
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014497crl-file <crlfile>
14498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14499 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14500 to verify server's certificate.
14501
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014502crt <cert>
14503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14504 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14505 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14506 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14507 certificate request.
14508
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014509 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14510 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14511 option is set accordingly).
14512
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014513disabled
14514 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14515 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14516 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14517 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14518 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014519 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014520
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014521enabled
14522 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14523 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14524 default value.
14525 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14526 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014528error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014529 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14530 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14531 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014533 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014535fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014536 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14537 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14538 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14539
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014540force-sslv3
14541 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14542 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014543 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014544 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014545
14546force-tlsv10
14547 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014548 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014549 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014550
14551force-tlsv11
14552 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014553 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014554 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014555
14556force-tlsv12
14557 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014558 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014559 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014560
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014561force-tlsv13
14562 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14563 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014564 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014566id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014567 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14568 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14569 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014570
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014571init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14572 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14573 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014574 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014575 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14576 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14577 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14578 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14579 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14580 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14581 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14582 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14583 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014584 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014585 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14586 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14587 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14588 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14589 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14590 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014591 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014592
14593 Example:
14594 defaults
14595 # never fail on address resolution
14596 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014598inter <delay>
14599fastinter <delay>
14600downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014601 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14602 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14603 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14604 between checks depending on the server state :
14605
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014606 Server state | Interval used
14607 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14608 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14609 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14610 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14611 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14612 or yet unchecked. |
14613 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14614 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14615 | "inter" otherwise.
14616 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014618 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14619 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14620 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14621 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014622 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14623 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14624 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14625 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14626 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014627
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014628log-proto <logproto>
14629 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14630 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14631 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14632 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014634maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014635 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14636 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014637 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14638 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014639 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14640 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14641 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14642 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14643
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014644 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14645 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14646 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14647 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14648 than 50 concurrent requests.
14649
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014650maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014651 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14652 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14653 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14654 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014655 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14656 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14657 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14658 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14659 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14660 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14661 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014662
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014663max-reuse <count>
14664 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14665 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14666 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14667 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14668 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14669 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14670 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14671 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014673minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014674 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14675 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14676 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14677 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14678 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14679 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014680 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014681 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014682
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014683namespace <name>
14684 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14685 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14686 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14687 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14688
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014689no-agent-check
14690 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14691 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14692 default value.
14693 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14694 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14695
14696no-backup
14697 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14698 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14699 default value.
14700 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14701 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14702
14703no-check
14704 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14705 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14706 default value.
14707 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14708 "default-server" "check" setting.
14709
14710no-check-ssl
14711 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14712 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14713 default value.
14714 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14715 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14716
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014717no-send-proxy
14718 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14719 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14720 default value.
14721 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14722 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14723
14724no-send-proxy-v2
14725 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14726 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14727 default value.
14728 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14729 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14730
14731no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14732 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14733 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14734 default value.
14735 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14736 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14737
14738no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14739 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14740 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14741 default value.
14742 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14743 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14744
14745no-ssl
14746 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14747 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14748 default value.
14749 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14750 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14751
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014752 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14753 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14754 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14755
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014756no-ssl-reuse
14757 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14758 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14759 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14760 and for paranoid users.
14761
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014762no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014763 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14764 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014765 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014766
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014767 Supported in default-server: No
14768
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014769no-tls-tickets
14770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14771 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14772 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014773 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14774 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014775 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14776 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14777 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014778 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014779
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014780no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014781 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014782 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14783 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014784 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14785 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014786 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014787
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014788 Supported in default-server: No
14789
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014790no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014791 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014792 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14793 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014794 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14795 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014796 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014797
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014798 Supported in default-server: No
14799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014800no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014801 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014802 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14803 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014804 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14805 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014806 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014807
14808 Supported in default-server: No
14809
14810no-tlsv13
14811 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14812 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14813 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14814 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14815 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014816 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014817
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014818 Supported in default-server: No
14819
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014820no-verifyhost
14821 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14822 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14823 default value.
14824 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14825 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014826
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014827no-tfo
14828 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14829 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14830 default value.
14831 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14832 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14833
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014834non-stick
14835 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14836 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14837 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14838
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014839npn <protocols>
14840 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14841 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14842 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014843 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014844 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14845 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14846 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014848observe <mode>
14849 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14850 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14851 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14852 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14853 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14854 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014855 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014856
14857 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014859on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014860 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14861 Currently, four modes are available:
14862 - fastinter: force fastinter
14863 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14864 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14865 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14866 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14867
14868 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14869
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014870on-marked-down <action>
14871 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14872 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014873 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14874 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14875 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14876 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14877 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14878 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14879 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14880 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014881
14882 Actions are disabled by default
14883
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014884on-marked-up <action>
14885 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14886 Currently one action is available:
14887 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14888 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14889 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14890 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014891 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14892 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014893 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14894 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14895
14896 Actions are disabled by default
14897
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014898pool-low-conn <max>
14899 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14900 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14901 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14902 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14903 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14904 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14905 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14906 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14907 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14908 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014909 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14910 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14911 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14912 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014913
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014914pool-max-conn <max>
14915 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14916 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14917 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14918 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14919 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14920 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14921
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014922pool-purge-delay <delay>
14923 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014924 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014925 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014927port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014928 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014929 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14930 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14931 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14932 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14933 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014934
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014935proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014936 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14937 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14938 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014939 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14940 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14941
14942 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14943 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14944 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14945 also reported (flag=HTX).
14946
14947 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14948 a server line :
14949
14950 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14951 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14952 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14953 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14954
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014955 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014956 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14957
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014958 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014960redir <prefix>
14961 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14962 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14963 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14964 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14965 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14966 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14967 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14968 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014969 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014971 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14972 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14973 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14974 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14975
14976 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014978rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014979 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14980 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14981 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14982
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014983resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14984 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14985 server.
14986
14987 Available options:
14988
14989 * allow-dup-ip
14990 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14991 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14992 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14993 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14994 For such case, simply enable this option.
14995 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14996
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014997 * ignore-weight
14998 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14999 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15000 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15001
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015002 * prevent-dup-ip
15003 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15004 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15005 same fqdn.
15006 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15007
15008 Example:
15009 backend b_myapp
15010 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15011 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15012 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15013
15014 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15015 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15016 it
15017 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15018 different address
15019
15020 Default value: not set
15021
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015022resolve-prefer <family>
15023 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15024 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15025 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15026 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15027
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015028 Default value: ipv6
15029
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015030 Example:
15031
15032 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015033
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015034resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015035 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015036 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015037 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015038 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15039 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015040 configured network, another address is selected.
15041
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015042 Example:
15043
15044 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015045
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015046resolvers <id>
15047 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15048 hostname.
15049
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015050 Example:
15051
15052 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015053
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015054 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015055
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015056send-proxy
15057 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15058 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15059 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15060 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015061 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15062 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15063 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15064 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015065 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015066 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15067 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15068 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15069 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15070 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015071 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15072 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015073
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015074send-proxy-v2
15075 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15076 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15077 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15078 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015079 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15080 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15081 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15082 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015083
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015084proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015085 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15086 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15087
15088 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15089 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15090 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15091 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15092 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15093 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15094 connection is supported).
15095 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15096 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15097 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15098 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15099 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15100 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15101 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015102
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015103send-proxy-v2-ssl
15104 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15105 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15106 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15107 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15108 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15109 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15110 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015111 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15112 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015113
15114send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15115 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15116 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15117 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15118 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15119 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15120 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15121 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15122 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015123 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15124 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015126slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015127 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15128 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15129 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15130 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15131 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15132 parameters :
15133
15134 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15135 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15136
15137 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15138 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15139 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15140 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15141
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015142 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015143 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15144 seen as failed.
15145
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015146sni <expression>
15147 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15148 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15149 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15150 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015151 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15152 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015153 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015154 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15155 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015156
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015157source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015158source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015159source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015160 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15161 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15162 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15163 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15164
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015165 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15166 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15167 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15168 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15169 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15170 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15171 server.
15172
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015173 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15174 specifying the source address without port(s).
15175
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015176ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015177 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15178 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15179 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15180 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15181 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15182 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015183 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15184 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015185
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015186ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15187 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15188 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15189 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15190
15191ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15192 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15193 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15194 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15195
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015196ssl-reuse
15197 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15198 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15199 default value.
15200 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15201 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15202
15203stick
15204 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15205 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15206 default value.
15207 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15208 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015209
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015210socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015211 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015212 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15213 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15214
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015215tcp-ut <delay>
15216 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015217 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015218 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015219 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015220 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15221 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15222 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15223 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15224 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15225 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15226 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15227 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15228 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15229
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015230tfo
15231 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15232 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15233 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15234 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015235 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015236 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015238track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015239 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15240 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15241 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15242 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015243 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15244
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015245tls-tickets
15246 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15247 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15248 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015249 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15250 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15251 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015253 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015254
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015255verify [none|required]
15256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015257 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015258 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15259 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015260 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015261 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15262 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15263 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15264 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15265 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15266 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15267 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15268 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015269
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015270verifyhost <hostname>
15271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015272 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15273 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15274 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15275 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15276 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15277 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15278 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15279 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015281weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015282 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15283 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15284 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015285 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15286 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15287 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15288 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15289 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15290 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015291
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015292ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15293 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15294 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15295 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15296
15297 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15298 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15299 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15300 server ALPN contains it.
15301
15302 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15303 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15304 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15305 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15306
15307 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15308 favor of the ALPN extension.
15309
15310 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015312
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153135.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15314-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015315
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015316HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15317using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015318configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015319This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15320can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15321workload.
15322This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15323resolution at run time.
15324Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15325carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15326
15327
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153285.3.1. Global overview
15329----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015330
15331As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15332different steps of the process life:
15333
15334 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15335 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15336 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15337
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015338 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15339 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015340
15341A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15342 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15343 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15344 resolution to know this new IP.
15345
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015346When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015347HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015348SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15349from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015350will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015351will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015352
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015353A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015354 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015355 first valid response.
15356
15357 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15358 servers return an error.
15359
15360
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153615.3.2. The resolvers section
15362----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015363
15364This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015365HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15366contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015367
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015368When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15369uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15370is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15371answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15372
15373When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015374used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015375
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015376 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15377 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15378 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015379
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015380 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15381 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015382
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015383 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15384 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15385 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015386
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015387For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15388following scenarios are possible:
15389
15390 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15391 ignored
15392
15393 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15394 applied
15395
15396 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15397 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15398
15399 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15400 retries the query with a new type
15401
15402 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15403 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015404
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015405As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015406a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015407<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015408
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015409
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015410resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015411 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015412
15413A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15414
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015415accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015416 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015417 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015418 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15419 by RFC 6891)
15420
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015421 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15422 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15423 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15424 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15425 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15426 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015427
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015428nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15429 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15430 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15431 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15432 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15433 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15434 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15435 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15436 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15437 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015438 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15439
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015440parse-resolv-conf
15441 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15442 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15443 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15444
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015445hold <status> <period>
15446 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15447 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015448 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015449 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015450 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15451 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15452 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15453
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015454 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015455
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015456resolve_retries <nb>
15457 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15458 giving up.
15459 Default value: 3
15460
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015461 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15462 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15463 type.
15464
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015465timeout <event> <time>
15466 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15467 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15468 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015469 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15470 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015471 Default value: 1s
15472 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015473 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015474 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015475 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15476 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15477
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015478 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015479
15480 resolvers mydns
15481 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15482 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015483 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015484 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015485 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015486 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015487 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015488 hold other 30s
15489 hold refused 30s
15490 hold nx 30s
15491 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015492 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015493 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015494
15495
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154966. Cache
15497---------
15498
15499HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15500(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15501RAM.
15502
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015503The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15504blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015505
15506If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15507independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15508when we try to allocate a new one.
15509
15510The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15511
15512It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15513"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15514for more details.
15515
15516When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15517replaced by "<CACHE>".
15518
15519
155206.1. Limitation
15521----------------
15522
15523The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15524
15525- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015526- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15527 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15528 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015529- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15530- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015531- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15532 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15533 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015534- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15535 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015536- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15537 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15538 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015539
15540- If the request is not a GET
15541- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15542- If the request contains an Authorization header
15543
15544
155456.2. Setup
15546-----------
15547
15548To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15549the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15550
15551
155526.2.1. Cache section
15553---------------------
15554
15555cache <name>
15556 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15557 size of cache is mandatory.
15558
15559total-max-size <megabytes>
15560 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15561 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15562
15563max-object-size <bytes>
15564 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15565 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15566 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15567
15568max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015569 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015570 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15571 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15572 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15573 default.
15574
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015575process-vary <on/off>
15576 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015577 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15578 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15579 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015580 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015581
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015582max-secondary-entries <number>
15583 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15584 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15585 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15586
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015587
155886.2.2. Proxy section
15589---------------------
15590
15591http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15592 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15593 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15594 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15595 after this one.
15596
15597http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15598 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15599 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15600 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15601 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15602
15603
15604Example:
15605
15606 backend bck1
15607 mode http
15608
15609 http-request cache-use foobar
15610 http-response cache-store foobar
15611 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15612
15613 cache foobar
15614 total-max-size 4
15615 max-age 240
15616
15617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156187. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15619----------------------------------
15620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15623The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15624these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15625but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15626data called patterns.
15627
15628
156297.1. ACL basics
15630---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015631
15632The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15633content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15634from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15635simple :
15636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015638 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15640 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15643adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015644
15645In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015648
15649This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15650Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15651and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015652an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15653conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15654as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15655are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015656
15657ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15658'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15659which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15660
15661There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15662performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15665specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15666this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015667methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15668ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669
15670Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15671 - boolean
15672 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15673 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15674 - string
15675 - data block
15676
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015677Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15678converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15679would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15680The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15681which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15682
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015683Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15684keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15685fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15686which are summarized in the table below :
15687
15688 +---------------------+-----------------+
15689 | Sample or converter | Default |
15690 | output type | matching method |
15691 +---------------------+-----------------+
15692 | boolean | bool |
15693 +---------------------+-----------------+
15694 | integer | int |
15695 +---------------------+-----------------+
15696 | ip | ip |
15697 +---------------------+-----------------+
15698 | string | str |
15699 +---------------------+-----------------+
15700 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15701 +---------------------+-----------------+
15702
15703Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15704matching method, see below.
15705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15707 - boolean
15708 - integer or integer range
15709 - IP address / network
15710 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15711 - regular expression
15712 - hex block
15713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015714The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15715
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015716 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15717 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015719 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015720 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015721 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015722 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15725read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15726if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15727lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15728will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15729beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015730a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15732exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15733
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015734The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15735parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15736ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15737a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15738check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15739
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015740The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15741socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15742file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15745loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15746
15747 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15748
15749In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15750the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15751case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15752as well.
15753
15754The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15755sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15756do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15757methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15758is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015759obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15761default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15762that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15763string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15764
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015765The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15766By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15767string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15768resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015769server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015770waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015771flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15772function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015774There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15775sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15776be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015777
15778 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15779 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15781 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15782 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15783 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015784
15785 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15786 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015788
15789 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015791
15792 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015795 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015796 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15797
15798 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15799 binary or string samples.
15800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15802 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15805 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15806 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15809 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015811 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15812 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15815 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15818 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015819 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15822 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15823 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015824
15825For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15826request, it is possible to do :
15827
15828 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15829
15830In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15831buffer, one would use the following acl :
15832
15833 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15834
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015835On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15836possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15837
15838 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15841criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15842method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15843to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15844criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15845the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015848the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15849For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15852 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15853 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15854 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015855
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015856
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015857The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15858types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15859combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15860brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15861default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863 +-------------------------------------------------+
15864 | Input sample type |
15865 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015866 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15868 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15869 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015870 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015872 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015874 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015876 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015878 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015880 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015882 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015884 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015886 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015888 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015890 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15892 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15893 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015894
15895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158967.1.1. Matching booleans
15897------------------------
15898
15899In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15900Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15901When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15902that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15903
15904Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15905return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15906"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159097.1.2. Matching integers
15910------------------------
15911
15912Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15913enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15914to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15915
15916Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15917matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15918lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015919
15920For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15921unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15922representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15923
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015924As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15925two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15926instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15927ranges and operators.
15928
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015929For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015930operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15931Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15932of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015934Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015935
15936 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15937 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15938 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15939 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15940 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015942For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015943
15944 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15945
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015946This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15947
15948 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15949
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159517.1.3. Matching strings
15952-----------------------
15953
15954String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15955different forms :
15956
15957 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959
15960 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015961 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962
15963 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15964 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15965
15966 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15967 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15968
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015969 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15971 matches.
15972
15973 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15974 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15975 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015976
15977String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15978exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15979characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15980string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15981to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015982before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015983
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015984Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15985(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15986Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15987
15988Example:
15989 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15990 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159937.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15994---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015995
15996Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15997they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15998possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15999passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16000the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016001the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16002match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016003
16004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160057.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16006-------------------------------------
16007
16008It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16009not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16010a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16011to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16012digits may be used upper or lower case.
16013
16014Example :
16015 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
16016 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
16017
16018
160197.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16020---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016021
16022IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16023netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16024within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016025host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016026difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16027at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16028does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16029parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016030
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016031The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16032abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16033
16034 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16035 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16036 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16037 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16038 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16039 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16040 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16041 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16042
16043Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16044192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16045
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016046IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16047Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16048trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16049IPv6 patterns.
16050
16051HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16052following situations :
16053 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16054 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16055 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16056 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16057 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16058 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16059 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16060 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16061 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16062 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064
160657.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16066----------------------------------
16067
16068Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16069combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16070
16071 - AND (implicit)
16072 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16073 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16080indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16083"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16084requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16085is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16086
16087 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016088 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16089 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16090 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091
16092To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16093and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16094
16095 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16096 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16097 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16098 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16099
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016100 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16102 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16103 use_backend www if host_www
16104
16105It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16106expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16107be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16108the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16109
16110 The following rule :
16111
16112 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016113 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114
16115 Can also be written that way :
16116
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016117 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118
16119It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16120to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16121simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16122sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16123good use is the following :
16124
16125 With named ACLs :
16126
16127 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16128 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16129 monitor fail if site_dead
16130
16131 With anonymous ACLs :
16132
16133 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16134
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016135See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16136keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137
16138
161397.3. Fetching samples
16140---------------------
16141
16142Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16143against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16144sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16145ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16146of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16147available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16148
16149This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16150Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16151compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16152deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16153
16154The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16155matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16156method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16157indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16158
16159As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16160when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16161mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16162the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16163ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16164
16165Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16166multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16167when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016168incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16169are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016170is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16171all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16172
16173Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16174 - name
16175 - name(arg1)
16176 - name(arg1,arg2)
16177
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016178
161797.3.1. Converters
16180-----------------
16181
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016182Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16183of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16184is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16185was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016186has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016187unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16188
16189These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16190sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16191the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016192support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016193
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016194A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16195support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16196supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16197(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16198bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016201
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001620251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16203 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16204 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16205 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16206 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16207 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16208
16209 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016210 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16211 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016212 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16213 frontend http-in
16214 bind *:8081
16215 default_backend servers
16216 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16217 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16218
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016219add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016220 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016221 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016222 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16223 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016224 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016225 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16226 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016231
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016232aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16233 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16234 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16235 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16236 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16237 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16238 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16239
16240 Example:
16241 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16242 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16243
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016244and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016245 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016246 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016247 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16248 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16251 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16252 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16253 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016254 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016255 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016256
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016257b64dec
16258 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16259 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016260 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16261 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016262
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016263base64
16264 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016265 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016266 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16267 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016268
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016269be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16270 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16271 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16272 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16273 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16274 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16275
16276 Example:
16277 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16278 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16279 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16280 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16281
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016282be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16283 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16284 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16285 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16286 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16287 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16288 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16289
16290 Example:
16291 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16292 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16293 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16294 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16295
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016296bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016297 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016298 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016299 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016300 presence of a flag).
16301
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016302bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16303 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16304 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016305 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016306
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016307concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16308 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16309 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16310 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16311 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16312 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16313 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16314 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16315 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16316 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16317 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016318 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016319 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016320 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016321 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16322 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16323 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016324
16325 Example:
16326 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16327 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16328 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016329 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016330 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016331 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16332
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016333cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016334 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16335 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016336
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016337crc32([<avalanche>])
16338 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16339 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16340 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16341 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16342 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16343 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16344 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16345 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16346 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16347 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016348 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16349
16350crc32c([<avalanche>])
16351 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16352 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16353 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16354 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16355 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16356 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16357 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16358 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016359
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016360cut_crlf
16361 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16362 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16363 updated.
16364
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016365da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016366 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16367 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16368 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16369 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016370 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016371 configuration language.
16372
16373 Example:
16374 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016375 bind *:8881
16376 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016377 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016378
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016379debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16380 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16381 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16382 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16383 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16384 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16385 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16386 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16387 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16388 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16389 printable sample types.
16390
16391 Example:
16392 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016393
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016394digest(<algorithm>)
16395 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16396 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16397
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016398 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016399 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016401div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016402 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16403 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016404 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016405 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16406 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016407 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016408 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16409 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16410 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16411 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016412 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016413 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016414
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016415djb2([<avalanche>])
16416 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16417 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16418 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16419 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16420 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16421 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16422 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016423 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16424 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016425
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016426even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016427 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016428 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16429
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016430field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16431 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16432 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16433 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16434 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16435 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16436 fields.
16437
16438 Example :
16439 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16440 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16441 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16442 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16443 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016444
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016445fix_is_valid
16446 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16447 Information eXchange):
16448
16449 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16450 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016451 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016452 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016453 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016454 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16455 checksum
16456
16457 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16458 the server can be parsed.
16459
16460 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16461 message, false if not.
16462
16463 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16464
16465 Example:
16466 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16467 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16468
16469fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16470 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16471 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16472 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16473 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016474 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016475 added.
16476
16477 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16478 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16479 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16480 fix_is_valid converter.
16481
16482 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16483
16484 Example:
16485 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16486 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16487 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16488 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16489 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016491hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016492 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016493 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016494 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016496
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016497hex2i
16498 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016499 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016500
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016501htonl
16502 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16503 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16504 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16505 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16506
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016507hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016508 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16509 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16510 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16511 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16512
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016513 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016514 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16515
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016516http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016517 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16518 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016519 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16520 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16521 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16522 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16523 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16524 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16525 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16526 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016528iif(<true>,<false>)
16529 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16530 string otherwise.
16531
16532 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016533 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016534
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016535in_table(<table>)
16536 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16537 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16538 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016539 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016540 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16541
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016542ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016543 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016544 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016545 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16546 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16547 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16548 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16549 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016550
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016551json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016552 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016553 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016554 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016555 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16556 of errors:
16557 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16558 bytes, ...)
16559 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16560 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16561
16562 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16563 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16564 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16565 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16566 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16567 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016568 - "ascii" : never fails;
16569 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16570 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016571 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016572 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016573 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16574 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16575
16576 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016578
16579 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016580 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016581 capture request header user-agent len 150
16582 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016583
16584 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16585 GET / HTTP/1.0
16586 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16587
16588 Output log:
16589 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16590
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016591json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16592 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16593 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16594 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16595 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16596
16597 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16598 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16599
16600 Example:
16601 # get a integer value from the request body
16602 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16603 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16604
16605 # get a key with '.' in the name
16606 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16607 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16608
16609 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16610 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16611
16612 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16613 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16614
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016615jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16616 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16617 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16618 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16619 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16620 json_path and output_type parameters.
16621
16622 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16623 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16624
16625jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16626 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16627 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16628 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16629 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16630 json_path and output_type parameters.
16631
16632 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16633 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16634
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016635jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16636 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16637 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016638 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016639 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16640 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16641 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16642 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016643
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016644 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16645 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16646 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16647 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016648
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016649 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16650 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16651 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16652 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16653 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16654 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
16655 be mentioned explicitely at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
16656 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16657
16658 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16659 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16660 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16661 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16662 contents.
16663
16664 The possible return values are the following :
16665
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016666 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16667 | ID | message |
16668 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016669 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
16670 | 1 | "Verification sucess" |
16671 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16672 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16673 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16674 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16675 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016676 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016677
16678 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16679 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16680
16681 Example:
16682 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16683 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16684 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16685 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16686 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16687 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16688
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016689language(<value>[,<default>])
16690 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16691 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16692 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16693 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16694 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16695 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16696 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16697 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16698 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016699 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016700 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16701 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016702
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016703 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016704
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016705 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16706 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016708 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16709 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16710 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16711 use_backend spanish if es
16712 use_backend french if fr
16713 use_backend english if en
16714 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016715
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016716length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016717 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16718 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16719 type. The result is of type integer.
16720
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016721lower
16722 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16723 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16724 type. The result is of type string.
16725
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016726ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16727 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16728 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16729 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16730 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16731 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16732 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16733
16734 Example :
16735
16736 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016737 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016738 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16739
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016740ltrim(<chars>)
16741 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16742 representation of the input sample.
16743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016744map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16745map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16746map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16747 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16748 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16749 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16750 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16751 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16752 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16753 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16754 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016755
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016756 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16757 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16758 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016759
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016760 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016761 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016762
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016763 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16764 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16765 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16766 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016767 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16768 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016769 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16770 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16771 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16772 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16773 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16774 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16775 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16776 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016777 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16778 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16779 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016780 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16781 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16782 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16783 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16784 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016785
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016786 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16787 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16788 the corresponding match text.
16789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016790 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16791 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16792 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16793 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16794 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016795
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016796 Example :
16797
16798 # this is a comment and is ignored
16799 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16800 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16801 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16802 | | | `---------- value
16803 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16804 | `---------------------------- key
16805 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16806
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016807mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016808 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16809 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016810 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016811 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016812 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016813 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16814 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16815 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016817 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016818 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016819
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016820mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016821 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16822 <packettype>.
16823 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16824 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16825 from.
16826 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16827 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16828 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16829
16830 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16831 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16832 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16833 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16834
16835 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16836 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16837 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16838 packets only):
16839 17: Session Expiry Interval
16840 33: Receive Maximum
16841 39: Maximum Packet Size
16842 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16843 25: Request Response Information
16844 23: Request Problem Information
16845 21: Authentication Method
16846 22: Authentication Data
16847 18: Will Delay Interval
16848 1: Payload Format Indicator
16849 2: Message Expiry Interval
16850 3: Content Type
16851 8: Response Topic
16852 9: Correlation Data
16853 Not supported yet:
16854 38: User Property
16855
16856 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16857 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16858 packets only):
16859 17: Session Expiry Interval
16860 33: Receive Maximum
16861 36: Maximum QoS
16862 37: Retain Available
16863 39: Maximum Packet Size
16864 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16865 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16866 31: Reason String
16867 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16868 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16869 42: Shared Subscription Available
16870 19: Server Keep Alive
16871 26: Response Information
16872 28: Server Reference
16873 21: Authentication Method
16874 22: Authentication Data
16875 Not supported yet:
16876 38: User Property
16877
16878 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16879 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16880 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16881 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16882
16883 Example:
16884
16885 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16886 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16887 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16888 if data_in_buffer
16889 # do the same as above
16890 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16891 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16892 if data_in_buffer
16893
16894mqtt_is_valid
16895 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16896
16897 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16898 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16899 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16900 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16901
16902 Example:
16903
16904 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016905 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016906
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016907mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016908 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016909 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16910 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016911 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016912 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016913 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016914 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16915 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16916 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16917 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016918 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016919 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016920
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016921nbsrv
16922 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16923 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16924 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16925 map lookup.
16926
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016927neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016928 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16929 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16930 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16931 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016932
16933not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016934 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016935 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016936 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016937 absence of a flag).
16938
16939odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016940 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016941 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16942
16943or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016944 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016945 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016946 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16947 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016948 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016949 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16950 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16951 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16952 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016953 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016954 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016955
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016956protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16957 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16958 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16959 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16960 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16961 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16962 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16963 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16964 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16965 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16966 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16967 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16968
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016969regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016970 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16971 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16972 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16973 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16974 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16975 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16976 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16977 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16978 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016979 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16980 of characters with other ones.
16981
16982 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16983 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16984 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16985 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16986 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16987 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016988
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016989 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016990
16991 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16992 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16993 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016994 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016995
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016996 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16997 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16998
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016999 # capture groups and backreferences
17000 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017001 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017002 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17003
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017004capture-req(<id>)
17005 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17006 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17007
17008 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017009 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17010 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017011
17012capture-res(<id>)
17013 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17014 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17015
17016 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017017 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17018 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017019
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017020rtrim(<chars>)
17021 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17022 of the input sample.
17023
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017024sdbm([<avalanche>])
17025 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17026 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17027 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17028 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17029 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17030 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17031 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017032 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17033 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017034
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017035secure_memcmp(<var>)
17036 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17037 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17038 match.
17039
17040 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17041 performed in constant time.
17042
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017043 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017044 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17045
17046 Example :
17047
17048 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17049 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17050 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17051 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17052
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017053set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017054 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
17055 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
17056 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017057 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017058 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17059 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017060 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017061 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17062 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017064 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017065
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017066sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017067 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017068 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17069
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017070sha2([<bits>])
17071 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17072 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17073
17074 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17075 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17076
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017077 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017078 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17079
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017080srv_queue
17081 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17082 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17083 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17084 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17085 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17086
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017087strcmp(<var>)
17088 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17089 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17090 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17091 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17092 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17093 shorter).
17094
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017095 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17096 strings in constant time.
17097
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017098 Example :
17099
17100 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17101 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17102 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17103
17104
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017105sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017106 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17107 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017108 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017109 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17110 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017111 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017112 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17113 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017114 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17116 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017118 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017119
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017120table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17124 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17125 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17126 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17127
17128
17129table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17133 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17134 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17135 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17136
17137table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017140 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017141 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17142 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17143
17144table_conn_cur(<table>)
17145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17148 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17149 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17150
17151table_conn_rate(<table>)
17152 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17153 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17154 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17155 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17156 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17157
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017158table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17161 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17162 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17163 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17164 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17165 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17166 data-type).
17167 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17168
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017169table_gpt0(<table>)
17170 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17171 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17172 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17173 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17174 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17175
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017176table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17177 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17178 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17179 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17180 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17181 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17182 between 0 and 99.
17183 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17184 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17185 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17186 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17187
17188table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17189 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17190 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17191 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17192 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17193 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17194 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17195 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17196 value 0.
17197 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17198 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17199 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17200
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017201table_gpc0(<table>)
17202 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17203 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17204 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17205 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17206 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17207
17208table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17212 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17213 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17214 sample fetch keyword.
17215
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017216table_gpc1(<table>)
17217 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17218 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17219 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17220 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17221 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17222
17223table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17227 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17228 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17229 sample fetch keyword.
17230
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017231table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17232 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17233 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017234 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017235 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17236 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17237
17238table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17239 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17240 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17241 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17242 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17243 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17244 keyword.
17245
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017246table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17249 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17250 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17251 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17252
17253table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17256 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17257 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17258 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17259 keyword.
17260
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017261table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17262 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17263 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017265 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17266 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17267
17268table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17269 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17270 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17271 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17272 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17273 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17274 keyword.
17275
17276table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17277 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17278 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017279 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017280 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17281 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17282 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17283 keyword.
17284
17285table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17286 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17287 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017288 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017289 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17290 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17291 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17292 keyword.
17293
17294table_server_id(<table>)
17295 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17296 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17297 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17298 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17299 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17300 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17301
17302table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17303 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17304 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017305 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017306 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17307 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17308 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17309 keyword.
17310
17311table_sess_rate(<table>)
17312 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17313 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17314 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17315 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17316 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17317 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17318 keyword.
17319
17320table_trackers(<table>)
17321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17323 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17324 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17325 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17326 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17327 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17328 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17329 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17330 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17331
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017332ub64dec
17333 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17334 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17335 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17336
17337 Example:
17338 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17339 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17340
17341ub64enc
17342 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17343
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017344upper
17345 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17346 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17347 type. The result is of type string.
17348
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017349url_dec([<in_form>])
17350 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17351 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17352 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17353 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17354 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17355 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017356
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017357url_enc([<enc_type>])
17358 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17359 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17360 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17361 optional argument is here for future changes.
17362
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017363ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017364 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017365 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17366 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17367 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017368 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17369 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17370 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17371 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017372 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017373 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17374 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017375
17376 Example:
17377 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17378 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17379
17380 message Point {
17381 int32 latitude = 1;
17382 int32 longitude = 2;
17383 }
17384
17385 message PPoint {
17386 Point point = 59;
17387 }
17388
17389 message Rectangle {
17390 // One corner of the rectangle.
17391 PPoint lo = 48;
17392 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17393 PPoint hi = 49;
17394 }
17395
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017396 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17397 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17398 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017399
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017400 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17401 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017402 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017403 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17404
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017405 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017406
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017407 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017408
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017409 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17410 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17411 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017412
17413 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17414 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17415 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17416
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017417 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17418 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17419 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017420
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017421
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017422unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017423 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17424 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17425 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17426 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17427 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17428 response),
17429 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17430 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17431 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17432 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17433
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017434utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17435 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17436 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17437 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17438 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17439 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17440 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17441
17442 Example :
17443
17444 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017445 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017446 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17447
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017448word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17449 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17450 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17451 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017452 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017453 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17454 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17455
17456 Example :
17457 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17458 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17459 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17460 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17461 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017462 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017463
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017464wt6([<avalanche>])
17465 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17466 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17467 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17468 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17469 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17470 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17471 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017472 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17473 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017474
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017475xor(<value>)
17476 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017477 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017478 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017479 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017480 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017481 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17482 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017483 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017484 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17485 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017486 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017487 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017488
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017489xxh3([<seed>])
17490 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17491 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17492 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17493 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17494 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17495 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17496 considered as cryptographically secure.
17497
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017498xxh32([<seed>])
17499 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17500 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17501 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17502 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17503 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17504 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17505 as cryptographically secure.
17506
17507xxh64([<seed>])
17508 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17509 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17510 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17511 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17512 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17513 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17514 as cryptographically secure.
17515
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017516
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017518--------------------------------------------
17519
17520A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17521not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17522"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17523The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17524
17525always_false : boolean
17526 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17527 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17528
17529always_true : boolean
17530 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17531 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17532
17533avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017534 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17536 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17537 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17538 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17539 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17540 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17541 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17542 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17543 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17544 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17545 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17546 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17547 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017549be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017550 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17551 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17552 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17553 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017554 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17555
17556be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17557 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17558 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17559 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17560 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17561 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017562 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17563 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017564
17565 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17566 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17567 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017569be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17570 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17571 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17572 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017573 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17575 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017576
17577 Example :
17578 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17579 backend dynamic
17580 mode http
17581 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17582 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017583
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017584bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017585 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17586 of the string.
17587
17588bool(<bool>) : bool
17589 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17590 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017592connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017594 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017595 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17596 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017597
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017598 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017599 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017600 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17601
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017602 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17603 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017604
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017605 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017606 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017607 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017608 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017609 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017610 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017611 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017612
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017613 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17614 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017616 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017617
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017618cpu_calls : integer
17619 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17620 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17621 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17622 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17623 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17624 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17625
17626cpu_ns_avg : integer
17627 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17628 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17629 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17630 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17631 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17632 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17633 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17634 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17635 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17636 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17637 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17638
17639cpu_ns_tot : integer
17640 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17641 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17642 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17643 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17644 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17645 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17646 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17647 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17648 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17649 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17650 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17651 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17652 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17653
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017654date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017655 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017656
17657 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17658 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17659 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017660 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17661
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017662 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17663 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17664 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17665 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17666 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17667
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017668 Example :
17669
17670 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17671 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017672
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017673 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17674 # millisecond granularity
17675 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17676
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017677date_us : integer
17678 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17679 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17680 from the same timeval structure.
17681
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017682distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17683 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17684 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17685 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17686 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017687 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017688 list of supported tokens.
17689
17690distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17691 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17692 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17693 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17694 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017695 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017696 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17697 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17698 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17699 supported tokens.
17700
17701 Example :
17702 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17703 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17704 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17705 # send large files to the big farm
17706 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17707
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017708env(<name>) : string
17709 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17710 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17711 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17712 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17713 certain way.
17714
17715 Examples :
17716 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17717 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17718
17719 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17720 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17723 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017724 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17725 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17727 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017728 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017729 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17730 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017731
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017732fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17733 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17734 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17735 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17739 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17740 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17741 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17742 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17743 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17744 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17745 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017746
17747 Example :
17748 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17749 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17750 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17751 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17752 frontend mail
17753 bind :25
17754 mode tcp
17755 maxconn 100
17756 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17757 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17758 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17759 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017760
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017761hostname : string
17762 Returns the system hostname.
17763
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017764int(<integer>) : signed integer
17765 Returns a signed integer.
17766
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017767ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17768 Returns an ipv4.
17769
17770ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17771 Returns an ipv6.
17772
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017773lat_ns_avg : integer
17774 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17775 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17776 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17777 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17778 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17779 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17780 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17781 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17782 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017783 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17784 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17785 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17786 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17787 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17788 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017789
17790lat_ns_tot : integer
17791 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17792 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17793 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17794 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17795 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17796 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17797 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17798 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17799 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017800 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17801 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17802 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17803 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17804 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017805 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17806 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17807 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17808 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17809 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17810 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17811
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017812meth(<method>) : method
17813 Returns a method.
17814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017815nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17817 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17818 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017819 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17820 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17821 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017822
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017823prio_class : integer
17824 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17825 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17826 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17827
17828prio_offset : integer
17829 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17830 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17831 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17832 set-priority-offset".
17833
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017834proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017835 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17836 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017838queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017839 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17840 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17841 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17843 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17844 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17845 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17846 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17847
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017848rand([<range>]) : integer
17849 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17850 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17851 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17852 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17853 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17856 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17857 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17858 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17859 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17860 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017861 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17862 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17863
17864srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17865 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17866 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17867 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17868 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17869 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17870 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17871 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17872
17873 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17874 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875
17876srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17877 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17878 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17879 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017880 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17882 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17883 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17884
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017885srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17886 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17887 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17888 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17889 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17890 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17891 fetch methods.
17892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017893srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17894 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17895 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017896 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17898 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017899 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900 overloading servers).
17901
17902 Example :
17903 # Redirect to a separate back
17904 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17905 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17906 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17907
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017908srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017909 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17910 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17911 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17912
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017913srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017914 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17915 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17916 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17917
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017918srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017919 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17920 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17921 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17922
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017923stopping : boolean
17924 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17925 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17926 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17927
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017928str(<string>) : string
17929 Returns a string.
17930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017931table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17932 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17933 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17934
17935table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17936 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17937 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17938 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17939
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017940thread : integer
17941 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17942 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17943 and debugging purposes.
17944
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017945uuid([<version>]) : string
17946 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17947 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17948 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17949
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017950var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017951 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017952 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
17953 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
17954 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17957 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017958 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017959 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17960 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017961 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017962 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017963
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965----------------------------------
17966
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017967The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17969methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17970sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17971TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017972the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17973counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017974"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17975used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17976can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17977Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17978table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17979tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17980currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017982bc_dst : ip
17983 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17984 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17985 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17986 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17987
17988bc_dst_port : integer
17989 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017990 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017991
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010017992bc_err : integer
17993 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
17994 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
17995 and their corresponding error message.
17996
17997bc_err_str : string
17998 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
17999 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18000 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18001 corresponding error message.
18002
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018003bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018004 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18005 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18006 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18007
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018008bc_src : ip
18009 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018010 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018011 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18012 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18013
18014bc_src_port : integer
18015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018016 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018018be_id : integer
18019 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018020 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18021 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018023be_name : string
18024 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018025 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18026 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018027
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018028be_server_timeout : integer
18029 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18030 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18031 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18032
18033be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18034 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18035 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18036 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18037
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018038cur_server_timeout : integer
18039 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18040 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18041 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18042
18043cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18044 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18045 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18046 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018048dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018049 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18050 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18051 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18052 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18053 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18054 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18055 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18056 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18057 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18058 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18059 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060
18061dst_conn : integer
18062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18063 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18064 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18065 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18066 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18067 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18068 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18069 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018070
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018071dst_is_local : boolean
18072 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18073 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18074 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18075 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018077 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18078 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18079 it only once per connection.
18080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081dst_port : integer
18082 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18083 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018084 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18085 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18086 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18087 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018088
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018089fc_dst : ip
18090 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18091 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18092 for details.
18093
18094fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18095 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18096 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18097 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18098
18099fc_dst_port : integer
18100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18101 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18102 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18103
18104fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018105 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18106 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18107 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018108 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018109 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18110
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018111fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018112 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018113 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018114 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018115 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18116
18117 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18118 | ID | message |
18119 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18120 | 0 | "Success" |
18121 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18122 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18123 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18124 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18125 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18126 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18127 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18128 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18129 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18130 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18131 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18132 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18133 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18134 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18135 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18136 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18137 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18138 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18139 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18140 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18141 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18142 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18143 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18144 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18145 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18146 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18147 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18148 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18149 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18150 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18151 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18152 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18153 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18154 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18155 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18156 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18157 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18158 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18159 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18160 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18161 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18162 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018163 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018164 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18165
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018166fc_fackets : integer
18167 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18168 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18169 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18170 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18171
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018172fc_http_major : integer
18173 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18174 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18175 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18176
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018177fc_lost : integer
18178 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18179 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18180 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18181 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18182
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018183fc_pp_authority : string
18184 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18185 if any.
18186
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018187fc_pp_unique_id : string
18188 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18189 if any.
18190
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018191fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18192 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18193 header.
18194
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018195fc_reordering : integer
18196 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18197 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18198 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18199 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18200
18201fc_retrans : integer
18202 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18203 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18204 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18205 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18206
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018207fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18208 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18209 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18210 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18211 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18212 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18213 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18214
18215fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18216 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18217 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18218 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18219 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18220 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18221 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18222
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018223fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018224 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18225 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18226 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18227 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18228
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018229fc_src : ip
18230 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18231 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18232 for details.
18233
18234fc_src_is_local : boolean
18235 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18236 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18237 "src_is_local" for details.
18238
18239fc_src_port : integer
18240
18241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18242 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18243 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18244
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018245
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018246fc_unacked : integer
18247 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18248 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18249 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18250 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018251
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018252fe_defbe : string
18253 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18254 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256fe_id : integer
18257 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018258 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18260
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018261fe_name : string
18262 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18263 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18264 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18265
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018266fe_client_timeout : integer
18267 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18268 current frontend.
18269
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018270sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018271sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18272sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18273sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018274 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18275 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18276 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18277
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018278sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018279sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18280sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18281sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018282 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18283 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18284 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18285
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018286sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18287 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18288 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18289 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18290 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18291 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18292 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18293 will always return zero.
18294 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18295 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18296
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018297sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018298sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18299sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18300sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018301 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18302 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018303 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18304 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18305 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018306
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018307 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018308 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18309 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018310 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18311 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18312 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018313 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18314 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18315
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018316sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18317sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18318sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18319sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18320 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18321 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18322 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18323 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18324 when a first ACL was verified.
18325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018326sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018327sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18328sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18329sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018330 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018331 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018333sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018334sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18335sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18336sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018337 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18338 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18339 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018341sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018342sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18343sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18344sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018345 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18346 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18347 See also src_conn_rate.
18348
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018349sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18350 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18351 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18352 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18353 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18354 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18355 index, zero is returned.
18356 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18357 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18358
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018359sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018360sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18361sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18362sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018363 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018364 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018365
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018366sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18367sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18368sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18369sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18370 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18371 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18372
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018373sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18374 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18375 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18376 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18377 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18378 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18379 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18380 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18381
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018382sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18383sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18384sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18385sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18386 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18387 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18388
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018389sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18390 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18391 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18392 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18393 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18394 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18395 between 0 and 2.
18396 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18397 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18398 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18399 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18400 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018402sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018403sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18404sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18405sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018406 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18407 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18408 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018409 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18410 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18411 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018412
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018413sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18414sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18415sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18416sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18417 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18418 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18419 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18420 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18421 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18422 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18423
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018424sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018425sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18426sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18427sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018428 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018429 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18430 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18431
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018432sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018433sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18434sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18435sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018436 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18437 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18438 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18439 src_http_err_rate.
18440
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018441sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18442sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18443sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18444sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18445 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18446 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18447 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18448
18449sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18450sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18451sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18452sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18453 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18454 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18455 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18456 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18457
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018458sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018459sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18460sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18461sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018462 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018463 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18464 src_http_req_cnt.
18465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018466sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018467sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18468sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18469sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018470 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18471 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18472 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18473 src_http_req_rate.
18474
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018475sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18476 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18477 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18478 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18479 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18480 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18481 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18482 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18483 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18484 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18485
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018486sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018487sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18488sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18489sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018490 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018491 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18492 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18493 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18494 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018495
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018496 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018497 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18498 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018499 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18500
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018501sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18502sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18503sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18504sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18505 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18506 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18507 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18508 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18509 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18510
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018511sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018512sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18513sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18514sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018515 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18516 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18517 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018518
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018519sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018520sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18521sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18522sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018523 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18524 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18525 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018526
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018527sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018528sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18529sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18530sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018531 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018532 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18533 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18534 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018535 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018536 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018538sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018539sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18540sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18541sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018542 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18543 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18544 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18545 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18546 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018547 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018549sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018550sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18551sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18552sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018553 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18554 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18555 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018557sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018558sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18559sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18560sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018561 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18562 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018563 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018564 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18565 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018566 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18567 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18568 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570so_id : integer
18571 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18572 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18573 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018574
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018575so_name : string
18576 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18577 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18578 strings instead of integers.
18579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018580src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018581 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18582 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18583 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18584 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18585 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18586 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18587 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18588 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18589 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18590 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18591 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18592 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18593 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18594 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18595 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018596
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018597 Example:
18598 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18599 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18602 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18603 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18604 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018605 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18608 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18609 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018610 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018611 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018612
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018613src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18614 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18615 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18616 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18617 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18618 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18619 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18620 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18621 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18624 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18625 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18626 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18627 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18628 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18629 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018630
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018631 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018632 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18633 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18634 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18635 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018636 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018637 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18638 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18639
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018640src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18641 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18642 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18643 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18644 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18645 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18646 was verified.
18647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018649 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018651 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018652 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018654src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018655 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18657 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018658 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18661 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18662 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18663 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018664 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018665
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018666src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18667 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18668 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18669 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18670 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18671 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18672 is returned.
18673 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18674 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18675 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018677src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018678 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018680 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018681 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018682
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018683src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18684 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18685 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18686 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18687 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18688
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018689src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18690 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18691 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18692 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18693 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18694 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18695 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18696
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018697src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18698 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18699 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18700 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18701 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18702
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018703src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18704 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18705 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18706 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18707 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18708 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18709 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18710 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18711 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18712 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18713 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018715src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018716 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018718 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18719 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018720 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18721 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18722 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018723
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018724src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18725 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18726 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18727 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18728 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18729 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18730 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18731 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018733src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018734 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018736 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018737 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018740src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18741 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18742 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18743 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18744 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018745 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018746
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018747src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18748 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18749 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018750 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018751 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18752 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18753
18754src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18755 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18756 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18757 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18758 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18759 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18760 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018763 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018764 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18765 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018766 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18769 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18770 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18771 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018772 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018773 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018774
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018775src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18776 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18777 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18778 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18779 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18780 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18781 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18782 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18783 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18786 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18787 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18788 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018789 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018790 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18791 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018792
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018793 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018794 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018795 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018796 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018797
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018798src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18799 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18800 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18801 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18802 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18803 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18804 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18805
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018806src_is_local : boolean
18807 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18808 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18809 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18810 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018811 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018812 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18813 once per connection.
18814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018816 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18817 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18818 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18819 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18820 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018823 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18824 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18825 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18826 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18827 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829src_port : integer
18830 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018831 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
18832 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
18833 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
18834 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018837 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018838 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18839 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18840 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018841 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18844 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18845 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18846 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18847 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018848 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18851 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18852 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18853 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18854 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18855 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18856 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18857 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18858 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018859
18860 Example :
18861 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18862 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18863 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18864 listen ssh
18865 bind :22
18866 mode tcp
18867 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018868 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018870 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872srv_id : integer
18873 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18874 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018875 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018876
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018877srv_name : string
18878 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18879 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018880 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018881
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018883----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018884
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018885The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18887when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18888usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018889future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018890
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001889151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18892 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18893 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18894 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18895 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18896 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18897
18898 Example :
18899 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18900 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18901 # the request.
18902 frontend http-in
18903 bind *:8081
18904 default_backend servers
18905 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18906 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18907
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018908ssl_bc : boolean
18909 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18910 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018911 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18912 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018913
18914ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18915 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018916 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18917 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018918
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018919ssl_bc_alpn : string
18920 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18921 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018922 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018923 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18924 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18925 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18926 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18927 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018928 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18929 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018930
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018931ssl_bc_cipher : string
18932 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018933 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18934 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018935
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018936ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18937 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18938 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18939 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018940 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018941
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018942ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018943 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018944 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
18945 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
18946 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
18947 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018948 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18949 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18950 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18951
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018952ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018953 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020018954 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
18955 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
18956 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018957
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018958ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18959 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18960 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018961 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18962 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018963
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018964ssl_bc_npn : string
18965 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18966 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018967 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018968 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18969 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18970 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18971 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018972 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18973 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018974
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018975ssl_bc_protocol : string
18976 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018977 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18978 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018979
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018980ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018981 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018982 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018983 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18984 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018985
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018986ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18987 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18988 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18989 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018990 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018991
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018992ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18993 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18994 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018995 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18996 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018997
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018998ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18999 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19000 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19001 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019002 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019003
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019004ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19005 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019006 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19007 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019009ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19010 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19011 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19012 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19013 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19014 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019016ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19017 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19018 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19019 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19020 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019021
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019022ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019023 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19024 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19025 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019026 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019027 does not support resumed sessions.
19028
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019029ssl_c_der : binary
19030 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19031 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19032 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034ssl_c_err : integer
19035 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19036 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19037 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19038 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19039 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019040
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019041ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19043 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19044 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19045 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19046 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19047 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19048 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19049 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019050 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19051 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19052 LDAP v3.
19053 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19054 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056ssl_c_key_alg : string
19057 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19058 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19059 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061ssl_c_notafter : string
19062 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19063 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19064 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019066ssl_c_notbefore : string
19067 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19068 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19069 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019070
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019071ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19073 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19074 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19075 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19076 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19077 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19078 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19079 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019080 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19081 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19082 LDAP v3.
19083 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19084 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086ssl_c_serial : binary
19087 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19088 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19089 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19092 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19093 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19094 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019095 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19096 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19097
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019098 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019099 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19102 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19103 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19104 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019106ssl_c_used : boolean
19107 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19108 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110ssl_c_verify : integer
19111 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19112 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19113 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19114 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116ssl_c_version : integer
19117 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19118 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019119
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019120ssl_f_der : binary
19121 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19122 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19123 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19124
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019125ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19127 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19128 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19129 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019130 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19132 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19133 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019134 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19135 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19136 LDAP v3.
19137 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19138 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140ssl_f_key_alg : string
19141 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19142 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19143 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019145ssl_f_notafter : string
19146 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19147 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19148 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019150ssl_f_notbefore : string
19151 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19152 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19153 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019154
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019155ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19157 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19158 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19159 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19160 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19161 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19162 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19163 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019164 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19165 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19166 LDAP v3.
19167 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19168 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170ssl_f_serial : binary
19171 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19172 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19173 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019174
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019175ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19176 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19177 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19178 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19181 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19182 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19183 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019185ssl_f_version : integer
19186 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19187 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19188
19189ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019190 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19191 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19192 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019194 Example :
19195 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19196 listen http-https
19197 bind :80
19198 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19199 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19200
19201ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19202 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19203 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19204
19205ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019206 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019207 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019208 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19210 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19211 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19212 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19213 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19214 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019216ssl_fc_cipher : string
19217 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19218 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019219
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019220ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19221 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19222 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019223 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019224 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19225 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19226 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019227
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019228 Example:
19229 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19230 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19231 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19232 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19233 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19234 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19235 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19236 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19237 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19238
19239ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019240 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019241 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019242 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19243 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019244 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19245 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019246
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019247ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019248 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019249 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019250 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019251 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19252 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19253 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19254 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19255 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19256 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019257
19258ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019259 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019260 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19261 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019262
19263ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19264 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19265 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019266 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019267
19268 Example:
19269 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19270 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19271 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19272 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19273 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19274 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19275 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19276 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19277 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19278
19279ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19280 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19281 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019282 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019283 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19284 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19285 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19286
19287 Example:
19288 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19289 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19290 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19291 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19292 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19293 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19294 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19295 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19296 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19297
19298ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19299 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19300 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019301 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019302 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19303 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19304 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19305
19306 Example:
19307 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19308 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19309 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19310 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19311 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19312 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19313 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19314 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19315 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019316
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019317ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19318 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19319 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19320 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19321
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019322ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19323 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19324 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19325 transport layer.
19326 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19327 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19328 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19329 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19330
19331ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19332 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19333 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19334 transport layer.
19335 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19336 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19337 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19338 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19339
19340ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19341 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19342 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19343 transport layer.
19344 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19345 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19346 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19347 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19348
19349ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19350 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19351 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19352 transport layer.
19353 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19354 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19355 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19356 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19357
19358ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19359 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19360 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19361 transport layer.
19362 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19363 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19364 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19365 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19366
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019367ssl_fc_err : integer
19368 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19369 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19370 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19371 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19372 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19373 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19374 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19375 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19376 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19377 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19378 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19379 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19380 codes.
19381
19382ssl_fc_err_str : string
19383 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19384 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19385 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19386 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19387 also "ssl_fc_err".
19388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019390 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19391 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019392 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19393 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19394 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19395 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019396
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019397ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19398 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19399 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19400 wait until the handshake happened.
19401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19403 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019404 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19405 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019406 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019407 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019408
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019409ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019410 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019411 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19412 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019415 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019416 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19418 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19419 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19420 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19421 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19422 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019424ssl_fc_protocol : string
19425 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19426 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019427
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019428ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19429 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19430 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019431 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19432 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019433
19434 Example:
19435 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19436 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19437 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19438 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19439 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19440 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19441 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19442 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19443 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19444
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019445ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019446 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019447 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019448 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019449
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019450ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19451 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19452 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19453 transport layer.
19454 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19455 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19456 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19457 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19458
19459ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19460 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19461 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19462 transport layer.
19463 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19464 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19465 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19466 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19467
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019468ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19469 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19470 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19471 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19474 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19475 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19476 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19477 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019478
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019479ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19480 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19481 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19482 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19483 BoringSSL.
19484
19485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486ssl_fc_sni : string
19487 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19488 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019489 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19491 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19492
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019493 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019494 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019496 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019497 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19501 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19504 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19505 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019506
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019507ssl_s_der : binary
19508 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19509 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19510 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19511
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019512ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19513 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19514 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19515 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019516 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019517 does not support resumed sessions.
19518
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019519ssl_s_key_alg : string
19520 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19521 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19522 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19523
19524ssl_s_notafter : string
19525 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19526 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19527 transport layer.
19528
19529ssl_s_notbefore : string
19530 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19531 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19532 transport layer.
19533
19534ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19535 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19536 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19537 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19538 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19539 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19540 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019541 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19542 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019543 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19544 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19545 LDAP v3.
19546 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19547 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19548
19549ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19550 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19551 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19552 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19553 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19554 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19555 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019556 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19557 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019558 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19559 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19560 LDAP v3.
19561 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19562 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19563
19564ssl_s_serial : binary
19565 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19566 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19567 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19568
19569ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19570 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19571 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19572 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19573
19574ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19575 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19576 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19577 layer.
19578
19579ssl_s_version : integer
19580 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19581 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019586Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19587sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19588only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19589For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19590be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19591can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19592sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19593for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19594content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019595
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019596Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19597 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019598 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019599 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19600 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19601 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19602 sample expression). So be careful.
19603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019604payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019605 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019606 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19607 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019609payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19610 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019611 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019612 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019614req.len : integer
19615req_len : integer (deprecated)
19616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19617 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19618 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19619 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19620 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019621 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019622 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19623 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019625req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19626 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019627 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19628 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19629 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19630 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632 ACL alternatives :
19633 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019635req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19636 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19637 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19638 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19639 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641 ACL alternatives :
19642 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019646req.proto_http : boolean
19647req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19648 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19649 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19650 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19651 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19652 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19653 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19654 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656 Example:
19657 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19658 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19659 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019660 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019662req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19663rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19664 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19665 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19666 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19667 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19668 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19669 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19670 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19673 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19674 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19675 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19676 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19677 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679 ACL derivatives :
19680 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019682 Example :
19683 listen tse-farm
19684 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19685 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19686 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19687 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19688 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19689 persist rdp-cookie
19690 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19691 # This is only useful makes sense if
19692 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19693 stick-table type string size 204800
19694 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19695 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19696 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19699 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019701req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19702rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19703 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19704 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19705 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19706 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708 ACL derivatives :
19709 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019710
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019711req.ssl_alpn : string
19712 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19713 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19714 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19715 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19716 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19717 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019718 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019719
19720 Examples :
19721 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19722 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19723 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019724 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019725 default_backend bk_default
19726
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019727req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19728 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19729 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019730 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19731 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19732 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19733 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19734 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19737req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19738 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19739 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19740 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19741 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19742 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19743 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19744 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019746req.ssl_sni : string
19747req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19748 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19749 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19750 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19751 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19752 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019753 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19754 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19755 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19756 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19757 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19758 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19759 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19760 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19761 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019764 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019766 Examples :
19767 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19768 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19769 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019770 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019771 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019772
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019773req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19774 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19775 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19776 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19777 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19778 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19779 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19780 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19781 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19782 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784req.ssl_ver : integer
19785req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19786 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19787 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19788 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19789 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19790 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19791 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19792 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019793 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019794 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796 ACL derivatives :
19797 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019798
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019799res.len : integer
19800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19801 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19802 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19803 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19804 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019805 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019806 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019807 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19810 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019811 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019812 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019813 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019814 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019816res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19817 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19818 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19819 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019820 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19821 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019824
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019825res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19826rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19827 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19828 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19829 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19830 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19831 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19832 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19833 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019835wait_end : boolean
19836 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19837 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019838 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019839 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19840 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019841 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019842 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19843 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845 Examples :
19846 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19847 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19848 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019850 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19851 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19852 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19853 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19854 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19855 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19856 tcp-request content reject
19857
19858
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198597.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019860--------------------------------------
19861
19862It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19863This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19864data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19865its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19866HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19867content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19868to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19869more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19870response are indexed.
19871
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019872Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19873 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19874 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19875 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19876 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19877 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19878 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019880base : string
19881 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19882 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19883 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19884 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19885 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19886 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19887 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19888 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19889
19890 ACL derivatives :
19891 base : exact string match
19892 base_beg : prefix match
19893 base_dir : subdir match
19894 base_dom : domain match
19895 base_end : suffix match
19896 base_len : length match
19897 base_reg : regex match
19898 base_sub : substring match
19899
19900base32 : integer
19901 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19902 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19903 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019904 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19905 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19906 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019907
19908base32+src : binary
19909 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19910 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19911 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19912 per-URL counters.
19913
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019914baseq : string
19915 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19916 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19917 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19918 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19919
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019920capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19921 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19922 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19923 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19924
19925capture.req.method : string
19926 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19927 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19928 because it's allocated.
19929
19930capture.req.uri : string
19931 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19932 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19933 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19934 allocated.
19935
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019936capture.req.ver : string
19937 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19938 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19939 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19940
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019941capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19942 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19943 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19944 The first entry is an index of 0.
19945 See also: "capture response header"
19946
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019947capture.res.ver : string
19948 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19949 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19950 persistent flag.
19951
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019952req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019953 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19954 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19955 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019956
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019957req.body_param([<name>) : string
19958 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19959 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19960 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19961 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19962 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19963 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19964 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19965 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19966 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19967 given.
19968
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019969req.body_len : integer
19970 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19971 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019972 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19973 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019974
19975req.body_size : integer
19976 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019977 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19978 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019980req.cook([<name>]) : string
19981cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19982 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19983 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19984 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19985 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19986 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19987 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19988 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19989 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19990
19991 ACL derivatives :
19992 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19993 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19994 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19995 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19996 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19997 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19998 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19999 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020001req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20002cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20003 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20004 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020006req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20007cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20008 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20009 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20010 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20011 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020013cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20014 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20015 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20016 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20017 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020018 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020019 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20020 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20021 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20022 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20025 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20026 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20027 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20028 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020029 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020031req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020032 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20033 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20034 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20035 with headers such as User-Agent.
20036
20037 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20038 found.
20039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020040 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20041 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20042 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020043 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020045req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20046 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20047 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020048 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20049 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020051req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020052 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20053 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20054 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20055 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20056 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20057 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20058 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20059
20060 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20061 found.
20062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020063 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20064 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20065 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020066 with -1 being the last one.
20067
20068 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20069 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020071 ACL derivatives :
20072 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20073 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20074 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20075 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20076 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20077 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20078 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20079 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20080
20081req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20082hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20083 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20084 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020085 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20086 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20087 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20088
20089 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20090 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20091 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20092
20093 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020094
20095req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20096hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20097 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20098 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20099 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020100 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20101 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20102 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20103 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20104 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020105
20106 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20107
20108 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020109
20110req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20111hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20112 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20113 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20114 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020115
20116 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20117
20118 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020120req.hdrs : string
20121 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20122 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20123 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20124 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20125
20126req.hdrs_bin : binary
20127 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20128 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20129 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20130 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20131 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20132 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20133
20134 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020135
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020136 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20137 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020139http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20140 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20141 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20142 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20143 basic auth is supported.
20144
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020145http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20146 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20147 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20148 performed on the data sent by the client.
20149 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20150 Authorization one.
20151
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020152http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20153 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20154 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20155 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20156 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020157 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20158 basic auth is supported.
20159
20160 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020161 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20162 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20163 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20164 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020165
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020166http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020167 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20168 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20169 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020170
20171http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020172 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20173 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20174 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020175
20176http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020177 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20178 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20179 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020181http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020182 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20183 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020184 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20185 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020187method : integer + string
20188 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20189 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20190 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20191 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20192 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20193 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20194 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020196 ACL derivatives :
20197 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020199 Example :
20200 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20201 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20202 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020204path : string
20205 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20206 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20207 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20208 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20209 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020210 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020211 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020213 ACL derivatives :
20214 path : exact string match
20215 path_beg : prefix match
20216 path_dir : subdir match
20217 path_dom : domain match
20218 path_end : suffix match
20219 path_len : length match
20220 path_reg : regex match
20221 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020222
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020223pathq : string
20224 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20225 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20226 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20227 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20228 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20229 result in both cases.
20230
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020231query : string
20232 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20233 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20234 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20235 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020236 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020237 which stops before the question mark.
20238
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020239req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20240 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20241 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20242 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20243 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020245req.ver : string
20246req_ver : string (deprecated)
20247 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20248 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20249 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020251 ACL derivatives :
20252 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020253
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020254res.body : binary
20255 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20256 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020257 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20258
20259 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020260
20261res.body_len : integer
20262 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20263 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020264 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20265
20266 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020267
20268res.body_size : integer
20269 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20270 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20271 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20272 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020273 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20274
20275 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020276
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020277res.cache_hit : boolean
20278 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20279 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20280
20281res.cache_name : string
20282 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20283 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20284 empty string.
20285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020286res.comp : boolean
20287 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20288 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20289 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020291res.comp_algo : string
20292 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20293 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20294 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020296res.cook([<name>]) : string
20297scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20298 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20299 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020300 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20301
20302 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020304 ACL derivatives :
20305 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020307res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20308scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20309 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20310 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020311 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20312
20313 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020315res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20316scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20317 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20318 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020319 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20320
20321 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020323res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020324 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20325 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20326
20327 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20328 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20329
20330 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20331
20332 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020334res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020335 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20336 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20337
20338 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20339 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20340
20341 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020343res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20344shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020345 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20346 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20347
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020348 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020349 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20350
20351 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020353 ACL derivatives :
20354 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20355 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20356 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20357 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20358 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20359 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20360 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20361 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20362
20363res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20364shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020365 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20366 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20367
20368 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020369 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020370
20371 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020373res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20374shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020375 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20376 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20377
20378 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20379
20380 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020381
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020382res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20383 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20384 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20385 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020386 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20387
20388 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020390res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20391shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020392 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20393 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20394
20395 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20396
20397 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020398
20399res.hdrs : string
20400 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20401 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20402 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020403 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20404
20405 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020406
20407res.hdrs_bin : binary
20408 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20409 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20410 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20411 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20412 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20413 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20414 (length of 0 for both).
20415
20416 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20417
20418 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20419 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020421res.ver : string
20422resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20423 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020424 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20425
20426 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020428 ACL derivatives :
20429 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020431set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20432 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20433 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020434 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020435 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020437 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20438 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020440status : integer
20441 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20442 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020443 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20444
20445 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020446
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020447unique-id : string
20448 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20449 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20450 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20451 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20452 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20453 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020455url : string
20456 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20457 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20458 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20459 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20460 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20461 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20462 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020464 ACL derivatives :
20465 url : exact string match
20466 url_beg : prefix match
20467 url_dir : subdir match
20468 url_dom : domain match
20469 url_end : suffix match
20470 url_len : length match
20471 url_reg : regex match
20472 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020474url_ip : ip
20475 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20476 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20477 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20478 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020479 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20480 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020482url_port : integer
20483 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020484 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020485
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020486urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20487url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020488 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20489 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020490 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20491 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20492 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20493 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020494 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20495 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020496 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20497 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020499 ACL derivatives :
20500 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20501 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20502 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20503 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20504 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20505 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20506 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20507 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020508
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020510 Example :
20511 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20512 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20513 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20514 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020515
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020516urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020517 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20518 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20519 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020520
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020521url32 : integer
20522 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20523 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20524 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20525 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20526 is an unsigned integer.
20527
20528url32+src : binary
20529 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20530 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20531 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20532
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020533
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200205347.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020535---------------------------------------
20536
20537This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20538used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20539purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20540There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20541or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20542any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20543for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20544
20545internal.htx.data : integer
20546 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20547 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20548
20549internal.htx.free : integer
20550 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20551 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20552
20553internal.htx.free_data : integer
20554 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20555 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20556
20557internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020558 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20559 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20560 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020561
20562internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20563 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20564 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20565
20566internal.htx.size : integer
20567 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20568 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20569
20570internal.htx.used : integer
20571 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20572 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20573 direction.
20574
20575internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20576 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20577 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20578 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20579 of the special value :
20580 * head : The oldest inserted block
20581 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020582 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020583
20584internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20585 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20586 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20587 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20588 integer or one of the special value :
20589 * head : The oldest inserted block
20590 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020591 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020592
20593internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20594 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20595 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20596 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20597 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20598
20599 * head : The oldest inserted block
20600 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020601 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020602
20603internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20604 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20605 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20606 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20607 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20608
20609 * head : The oldest inserted block
20610 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020611 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020612
20613internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20614 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20615 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20616 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20617 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20618
20619 * head : The oldest inserted block
20620 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020621 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020622
20623internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20624 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20625 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20626 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20627 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20628
20629 * head : The oldest inserted block
20630 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020631 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020632
20633internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20634 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20635 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20636 it returns false.
20637
20638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200206397.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020640---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020642Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20643every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020644order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020646ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020647---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20648FALSE always_false never match
20649HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20650HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20651HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020652HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020653HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20654HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20655HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20656HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020020657LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020658METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20659METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20660METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20661METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20662METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20663METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20664METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20665METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20666RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20667REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20668TRUE always_true always match
20669WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20670---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020671
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206738. Logging
20674----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020676One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20677provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20678very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20679provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20680state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020681to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020682headers.
20683
20684In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20685about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20686send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20687
20688 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20689 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20690 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20691 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20692 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020693 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020694 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020695
20696The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20697allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20698as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20699while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20700real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20701delay.
20702
20703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207048.1. Log levels
20705---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020706
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020707TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020708source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020709HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20710in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20711track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20712syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20713about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020714
20715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207168.2. Log formats
20717----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020718
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020719HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020720and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20721slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20722options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723
20724 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20725 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20726 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20727 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20728 extents.
20729
20730 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20731 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20732 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20733 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20734 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20735
20736 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20737 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20738 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20739 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20740 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20741
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020742 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20743 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20744 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20745 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20746
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020747 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20748
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020749Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20750specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20751field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20752servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20753always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20754identifier.
20755
20756Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20757 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20758 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20759 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20760 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20761
20762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207638.2.1. Default log format
20764-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020765
20766This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20767as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20768format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20769
20770 Example :
20771 listen www
20772 mode http
20773 log global
20774 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20775
20776 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20777 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20778 (www/HTTP)
20779
20780 Field Format Extract from the example above
20781 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20782 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20783 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20784 4 'to' to
20785 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20786 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20787
20788Detailed fields description :
20789 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20790 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20791 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20792 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20793 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20794 and processed the connection.
20795 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20796
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020797In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20798"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20799connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20800
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020801It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20802will eventually disappear.
20803
20804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208058.2.2. TCP log format
20806---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020807
20808The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20809is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20810information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20811counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20812emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20813environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20814the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20815sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020816specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020817not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20818
20819The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
20820exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010020821if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020822
20823 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
20824 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20825 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
20826
20827A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
20828are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829
20830 Example :
20831 frontend fnt
20832 mode tcp
20833 option tcplog
20834 log global
20835 default_backend bck
20836
20837 backend bck
20838 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20839
20840 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20841 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20842 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20843
20844 Field Format Extract from the example above
20845 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20846 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20847 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20848 4 frontend_name fnt
20849 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20850 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20851 7 bytes_read* 212
20852 8 termination_state --
20853 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20854 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20855
20856Detailed fields description :
20857 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020858 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020859 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20860 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020861 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020862 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020863 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020864
20865 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020866 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20867 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20868 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020869
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020870 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20872 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020873 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20874 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20875 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20876 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020877
20878 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20879 and processed the connection.
20880
20881 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20882 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20883 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20884 applications.
20885
20886 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20887 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20888 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20889 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20890 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20891
20892 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20893 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20894 See "Timers" below for more details.
20895
20896 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20897 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20898 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20899 "Timers" below for more details.
20900
20901 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020902 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020903 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20904 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20905 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20906 details.
20907
20908 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20909 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20910 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20911 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20912 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20913
20914 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20915 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20916 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20917 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20918 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20919 for more details.
20920
20921 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020922 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20924 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20925 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020926 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020927
20928 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20929 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20930 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20931 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20932 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20933 caused by a denial of service attack.
20934
20935 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20936 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20937 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20938 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20939 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20940 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20941 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20942 denial of service attack.
20943
20944 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20945 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20946 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20947 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20948 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20949 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20950 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20951 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20952 be processed than on other servers.
20953
20954 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20955 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20956 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20957 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020958 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020959 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20960 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20961 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20962 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20963 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20964 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20965 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20966 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20967
20968 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20969 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20970 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20971 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20972 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20973 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020974 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020975 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20976
20977 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20978 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20979 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20980 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20981 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20982 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020983 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020984 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20985 occurs.
20986
20987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209888.2.3. HTTP log format
20989----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020990
20991The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20992is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20993the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20994are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20995emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20996generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20997"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20998which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020999frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21000is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021002The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21003exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021004if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021005
21006 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21007 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21008 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21009
21010And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21011this exact string:
21012
21013 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21014 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21015 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21016 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21017
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021018Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21019slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21020with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21021
21022 Example :
21023 frontend http-in
21024 mode http
21025 option httplog
21026 log global
21027 default_backend bck
21028
21029 backend static
21030 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21031
21032 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21033 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21034 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021035 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036
21037 Field Format Extract from the example above
21038 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21039 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021040 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041 4 frontend_name http-in
21042 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021043 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021044 7 status_code 200
21045 8 bytes_read* 2750
21046 9 captured_request_cookie -
21047 10 captured_response_cookie -
21048 11 termination_state ----
21049 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21050 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21051 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21052 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21053 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021054
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055Detailed fields description :
21056 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021057 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021058 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21059 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021060 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021061 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021062 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063
21064 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021065 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21066 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21067 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021069 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021070 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071
21072 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21073 and processed the connection.
21074
21075 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21076 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21077 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21078
21079 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21080 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21081 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21082 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21083 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21084 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21085
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021086 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21087 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21088 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021089 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021090 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21091 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021092 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021093 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021094
21095 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21096 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021097 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021098
21099 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21100 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021101 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21102 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021103
21104 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21105 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21106 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21107 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21108 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021109 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21110 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021111
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021112 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021113 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21114 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21115 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21116 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21117 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21118 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021119 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
21121 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021122 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21123 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
21125 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21126 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021127 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21129 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21130 overflowing.
21131
21132 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21133 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21134 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21135 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21136 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21137 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21138 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21139 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21140
21141 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21142 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21143 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21144 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21145 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21146 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21147 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21148 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21149
21150 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21151 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21152 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21153 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21154 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21155 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21156 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21157
21158 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021159 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021160 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21161 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21162 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021163 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021164 system.
21165
21166 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21167 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21168 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21169 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21170 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21171 caused by a denial of service attack.
21172
21173 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21174 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21175 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21176 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21177 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21178 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21179 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21180 denial of service attack.
21181
21182 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21183 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21184 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21185 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21186 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21187 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21188 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21189 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21190 processed than on other servers.
21191
21192 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21193 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21194 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21195 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021196 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021197 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21198 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21199 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21200 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21201 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21202 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21203 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21204 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21205
21206 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21207 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21208 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21209 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21210 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21211 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021212 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021213 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21214
21215 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21216 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21217 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21218 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21219 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21220 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021221 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021222 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21223 occurs.
21224
21225 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21226 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21227 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21228 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21229 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21230 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21231 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21232 cookies" below for more details.
21233
21234 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21235 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21236 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21237 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21238 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21239 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21240 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21241 and cookies" below for more details.
21242
21243 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21244 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21245 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21246 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21247 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21248 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21249 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21250 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21251
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021252
212538.2.4. HTTPS log format
21254----------------------
21255
21256The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21257extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21258information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21259frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21260end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21261matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21262sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21263dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21264"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21265
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021266The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21267exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021268if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021269
21270 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21271 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21272 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21273 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021274 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021275
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021276This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21277appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21278HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021280 Example :
21281 frontend https-in
21282 mode http
21283 option httpslog
21284 log global
21285 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21286 default_backend bck
21287
21288 backend static
21289 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21290
21291 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21292 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21293 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021294 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21295 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021296
21297 Field Format Extract from the example above
21298 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21299 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21300 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21301 4 frontend_name https-in
21302 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21303 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21304 7 status_code 200
21305 8 bytes_read* 2750
21306 9 captured_request_cookie -
21307 10 captured_response_cookie -
21308 11 termination_state ----
21309 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21310 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21311 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21312 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21313 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021314 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021315 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021316 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21317 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021318
21319Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021320 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21321 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21322 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021323
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021324 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21325 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21326 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021327 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021328 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021329
21330 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21331 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21332 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21333 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21334
21335 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21336 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21337 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21338 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21339
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021340 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21341 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21342 can be shared by multiple requests.
21343
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021344 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21345 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21346 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21347 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21348 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21349
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021350 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21351
21352 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21353
21354
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100213558.2.5. Error log format
21356-----------------------
21357
21358When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21359protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21360unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21361line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21362"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21363will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21364logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21365
21366The default format looks like this :
21367
21368 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21369 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21370 Connection error during SSL handshake
21371
21372 Field Format Extract from the example above
21373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21374 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21375 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21376 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21377 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21378
21379These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21380failures.
21381
21382By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21383above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21384defined format.
21385
21386An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21387source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21388number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21389internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21390error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21391the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21392certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21393indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21394indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21395ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21396are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21397would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21398regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21399
21400 # detailed frontend connection error log
21401 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_conn_err]/\
21402 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21403 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21404
21405
214068.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021407------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021408
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021409When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21410ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21411a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21412formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21413looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21414and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021415
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021416HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021417Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21418separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21419prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21420
21421Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21422variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021423("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021424
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021425If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021426as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021427less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21428the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21429
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021430Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21431"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21432delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21433preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021434
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021435Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21436'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21437https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21438such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21439
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021440Flags are :
21441 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021442 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021443 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21444 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021445
21446 Example:
21447
21448 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21450
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021451 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21452
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021453Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21454
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021455 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021456 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021457 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21458 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21459 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021460 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21461 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21462 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021463 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021464 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021465 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021466 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021467 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021468 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21469 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021470 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021471 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021472 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021473 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021474 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021475 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021476 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021477 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21478 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21479 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21480 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21481 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021482 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021483 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021484 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021485 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021486 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021487 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21488 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021489 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21490 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21491 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021492 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021493 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21494 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021495 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021496 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21497 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21498 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021499 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021500 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021501 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21502 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21503 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21504 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021505 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021506 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021507 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021508 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021509 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021510 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021511 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21512 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21513 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021514 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021515 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21516 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021517 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021518 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21519 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021520 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021521 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021522 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021523 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021524
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021525 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021526
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215288.3. Advanced logging options
21529-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021530
21531Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21532just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21533options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21534for more information about their usage.
21535
21536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215378.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21538------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021539
21540It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021541HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021542commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21543monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21544ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21545
21546 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21547 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21548 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21549 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21550
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021551 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21552 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021553
21554 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21555 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21556 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21557
21558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215598.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21560----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561
21562The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21563what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21564or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021565"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021566just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21567log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21568after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21569is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21570with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21571with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21572
21573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215748.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21575------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021576
21577Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21578for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21579"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21580retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21581raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21582a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21583file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21584you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21585"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21586
21587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215888.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21589--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021590
21591Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21592multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21593them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21594"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21595logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21596error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21597and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21598too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21599useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21600alternative.
21601
21602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216038.4. Timing events
21604------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021605
21606Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21607reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21608the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21609frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021610mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21611addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21612
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021613Timings events in HTTP mode:
21614
21615 first request 2nd request
21616 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21617 t tr t tr ...
21618 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21619 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21620 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21621 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021622 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021623 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21624
21625Timings events in TCP mode:
21626
21627 TCP session
21628 |<----------------->|
21629 t t
21630 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21631 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21632 |<------ Tt ------->|
21633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021634 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021635 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021636 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21637 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21638 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021639 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021640 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21641 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21642 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21643 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021644
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021645 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21646 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21647 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021648 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21649 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21650 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21651 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21652 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21653 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021654
21655 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21656 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21657 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21658 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21659 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21660 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21661 request typed by hand during a test.
21662
21663 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21664 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021665 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021666 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21667 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21668 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21669 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021670
21671 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21672 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21673 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21674 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21675 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21676
21677 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21678 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21679 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21680 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21681 connection never established.
21682
21683 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21684 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21685 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21686 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21687 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21688 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21689 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21690 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21691 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21692 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21693 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021695 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21696 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21697 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21698 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21699 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21700 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21701
21702 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21703
21704 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21705 "Ta" can never be negative.
21706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021707 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21708 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021709 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21710 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021711 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021712
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021713 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021714
21715 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021716 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21717 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021718
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021719 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21720 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21721 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21722 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21723 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21724 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21725 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21726 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21727
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021728These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21729protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21730that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021731due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21732"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21733that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021734
21735Most common cases :
21736
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021737 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21738 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21739 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21740 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21741 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021742 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021743 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21744 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21745 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21746 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21747 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021748 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021749
21750 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21751 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21752 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21753 of ms on remote networks.
21754
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021755 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21756 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21757 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021758
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021759 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21760 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021761 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021762 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21763 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21764 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21765 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21766 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21767 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021768
21769Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21770
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021771 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021772 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021773 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021774
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021775 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021776 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21777 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21778
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021779 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021780 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21781 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21782 flags.
21783
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021784 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21785 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021786 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21787 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21788 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21789 the client connection was maintained open.
21790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021791 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021792 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021793 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021794 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21795
21796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217978.5. Session state at disconnection
21798-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021799
21800TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21801"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
218022-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21803each of which has a special meaning :
21804
21805 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21806 session to terminate :
21807
21808 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21809
21810 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21811 server explicitly refused it.
21812
21813 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21814 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21815 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21816 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021817 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021818
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021819 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021820 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021821
21822 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21823 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21824 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21825 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21826 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21827
21828 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21829 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21830 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21831 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21832 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21833
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021834 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021835 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21836
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021837 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021838 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21839 backup connections when going up.
21840
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021841 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021843 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21844 send or receive data.
21845
21846 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21847 send or receive data.
21848
21849 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21850 with nothing left in the buffers.
21851
21852 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21853
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021854 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021855 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21856
21857 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21858 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21859 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21860 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21861 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21862
21863 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21864 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21865
21866 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21867 server (HTTP only).
21868
21869 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21870
21871 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21872 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21873 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21874
21875 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21876 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21877 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21878
21879 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21880
21881 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21882 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21883
21884 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21885 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21886 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21887
21888 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21889 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021890 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21891 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021892
21893 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21894 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21895 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21896 another server.
21897
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021898 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021899 server.
21900
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021901 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21902 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21903 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21904 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21905
21906 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21907 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21908 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21909 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21910
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021911 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21912 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21913 "use-server" rule).
21914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021915 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21916
21917 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21918 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21919
21920 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21921
21922 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21923 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21924 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21925
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021926 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21927 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021928 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021929 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21930 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021932 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21933
21934 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21935 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21936
21937 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21938
21939 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21940
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021941The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21942was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021943helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21944starvation, attacks, etc...
21945
21946The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21947alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21948easier finding and understanding.
21949
21950 Flags Reason
21951
21952 -- Normal termination.
21953
21954 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021955 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21956 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021957 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21958
21959 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21960 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021961 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21962 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021963 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21964 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021965
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021966 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21967 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021968 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021969
21970 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21971 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21972 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21973
21974 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21975 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21976 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21977 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21978 the server takes too long to respond.
21979
21980 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21981 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21982 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21983 long a time to respond.
21984
21985 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21986 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21987 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021988 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021989 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21990 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021991
21992 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21993 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21994 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21995 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21996 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021997 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021998 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21999 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22000 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22001 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22002 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22003 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22004 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22005 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022006 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022007 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22008 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22009 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022010
22011 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22012 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022013 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22014 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22015 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22016 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022017
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022018 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022019 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22020
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022021 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022022 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22023 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022024 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022025 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22026 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22027
22028 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22029 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22030 503 or 504 here.
22031
22032 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022033 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022034 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22035 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22036 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22037
22038 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22039 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022040 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022041 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022042 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022043
22044 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22045 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22046 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22047 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22048 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22049 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022050 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022051
22052 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22053 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22054 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22055 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22056 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22057 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22058 solution is to fix the application.
22059
22060 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22061 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22062 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22063 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22064 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22065 external attacks.
22066
22067 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022068 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022069 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022070 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22071 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22072
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022073 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22074 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22075 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022076 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022077 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022078
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022079 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22080 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22081 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22082 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022083 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22084 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22085 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22086 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
22087 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022088
22089 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22090 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22091 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
22092 returned an HTTP 403 error.
22093
22094 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22095 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22096 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22097 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22098
22099 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22100 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22101 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22102 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22103
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022104The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022105persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022106important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22107re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22108
22109 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22110
22111 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22112 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22113 set on a GET request.
22114
22115 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22116 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022117 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022118 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22119
22120 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22121 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22122 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22123
22124 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22125 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22126 already got a cookie.
22127
22128 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22129 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22130 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22131 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22132 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22133
22134 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22135 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22136 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22137
22138 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22139 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22140 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22141
22142 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22143 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22144
22145 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22146 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22147 then advertised in the response.
22148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221508.6. Non-printable characters
22151-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022152
22153In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22154consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22155converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22156prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22157being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22158escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22159is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22160'}' when logging headers.
22161
22162Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22163issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22164containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22165
22166Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22167the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22168performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22169
22170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221718.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22172---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022173
22174Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22175achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022176section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022177cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22178the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22179the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022180locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022181not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22182user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22183a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22184wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22185
22186 Examples :
22187 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22188 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22189
22190 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22191 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22192
22193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221948.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22195---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022196
22197Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22198proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22199the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22200server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22201
22202Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22203response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022204section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022205
22206It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022207time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22208appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022209are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22210and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22211follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22212request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22213in the logs.
22214
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022215As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22216frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22217an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22218
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022219 Example :
22220 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22221 listen proxy-out
22222 mode http
22223 option httplog
22224 option logasap
22225 log global
22226 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22227
22228 # log the name of the virtual server
22229 capture request header Host len 20
22230
22231 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22232 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22233
22234 # log the beginning of the referrer
22235 capture request header Referer len 20
22236
22237 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22238 capture response header Server len 20
22239
22240 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22241 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22242
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022243 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022244 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22245
22246 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22247 capture response header Via len 20
22248
22249 # log the URL location during a redirection
22250 capture response header Location len 20
22251
22252 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22253 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22254 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22255 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22256 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22257
22258 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22259 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22260 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22261 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022262 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022263
22264 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22265 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22266 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22267 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22268 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022269 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022270
22271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222728.9. Examples of logs
22273---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022274
22275These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22276them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22277reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22278
22279 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22280 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22281 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22282
22283 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22284 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22285
22286 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22287 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22288 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22289
22290 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22291 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22292
22293 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22294 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22295 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22296
22297 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022298 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022299 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22300 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22301
22302 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22303 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22304 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22305
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022306 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22307 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22308 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22309 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022310 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022311 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022312
22313 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022314 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022315
22316 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22317 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22318 Nothing was sent to any server.
22319
22320 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22321 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22322
22323 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22324 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022325 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022326 send a 408 return code to the client.
22327
22328 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22329 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22330
22331 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22332 5 seconds ("c----").
22333
22334 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22335 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022336 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022337
22338 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022339 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022340 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22341 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22342 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22343 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22344 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022345
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022346
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200223479. Supported filters
22348--------------------
22349
22350Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22351accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22352unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22353
22354See also : "filter"
22355
223569.1. Trace
22357----------
22358
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022359filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022360
22361 Arguments:
22362 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22363 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22364
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022365 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022367 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022368 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22369 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22370 amount of the parsed data.
22371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022372 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022373
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022374This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22375callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22376information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22377filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22378
22379Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22380tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22381a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22382
22383
223849.2. HTTP compression
22385---------------------
22386
22387filter compression
22388
22389The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22390keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022391when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22392fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22393done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22394explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22395filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22396listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22397order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022398
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022399See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22400 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022401
22402
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200224039.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22404--------------------------------------------
22405
22406filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22407
22408 Arguments :
22409
22410 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22411 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22412 parsed.
22413
22414 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22415 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22416 part must be placed in its own scope.
22417
22418The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22419external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022420streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022421exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22422also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22423
22424SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22425the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22426
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022427For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022428"doc/SPOE.txt".
22429
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100224309.4. Cache
22431----------
22432
22433filter cache <name>
22434
22435 Arguments :
22436
22437 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22438
22439The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22440"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022441cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022442other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22443case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22444is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22445filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022446listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22447order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022448
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022449See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22450 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22451
22452
224539.5. Fcgi-app
22454-------------
22455
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022456filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022457
22458 Arguments :
22459
22460 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22461
22462The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22463request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22464reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22465used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22466implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22467used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22468fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22469used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22470order.
22471
22472See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22473 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22474
22475
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100224769.6. OpenTracing
22477----------------
22478
22479The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22480HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22481of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22482Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022484This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022485
22486The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22487HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22488participates in the work of HAProxy.
22489
22490filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22491
22492 Arguments :
22493
22494 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22495 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22496 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22497 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22498 OpenTracing filters.
22499
22500 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22501 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22502 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22503 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22504 filter must have its own scope defined.
22505
22506More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022507of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022508
22509
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002251010. FastCGI applications
22511-------------------------
22512
22513HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22514feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22515the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22516FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22517servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22518FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22519backend.
22520
22521HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22522application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22523connection.
22524
2252510.1. Setup
22526-----------
22527
2252810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22529--------------------------
22530
22531fcgi-app <name>
22532 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22533 document root must be defined.
22534
22535acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22536 Declare or complete an access list.
22537
22538 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22539 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22540 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22541 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22542 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22543
22544docroot <path>
22545 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22546 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22547 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22548
22549index <script-name>
22550 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22551 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22552 is an optional setting.
22553
22554 Example :
22555 index index.php
22556
22557log-stderr global
22558log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022559 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022560 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22561
22562 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22563 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22564
22565pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22566 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22567 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22568 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22569
22570 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22571 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22572 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22573 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22574
22575 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22576 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22577
22578path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022579 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022580 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22581 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22582 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22583 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22584 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22585 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22586 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022587
22588 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022589 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022590 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22591 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22592 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22593 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022594
22595 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022596 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22597 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022598
22599option get-values
22600no option get-values
22601 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22602
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022603 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022604 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22605
22606 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22607 application will accept.
22608
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022609 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22610 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022611
22612 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022613 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022614 option is disabled.
22615
22616 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22617 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22618 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22619 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22620 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22621 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22622
22623option keep-conn
22624no option keep-conn
22625 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22626 sending a response.
22627
22628 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22629 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22630
22631option max-reqs <reqs>
22632 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22633 accept.
22634
22635 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22636 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22637 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22638 to 1.
22639
22640option mpxs-conns
22641no option mpxs-conns
22642 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22643
22644 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22645 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22646
22647set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22648 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22649 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22650 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22651 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22652
22653 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22654 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22655 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22656
22657 Example :
22658 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22659 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22660
22661 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22662
22663
2266410.1.2. Proxy section
22665---------------------
22666
22667use-fcgi-app <name>
22668 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22669
22670 Arguments :
22671 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22672
22673 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22674 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22675 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22676 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22677 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22678
22679 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22680 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22681 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22682 application are evaluated.
22683
22684
2268510.1.3. Example
22686---------------
22687
22688 frontend front-http
22689 mode http
22690 bind *:80
22691 bind *:
22692
22693 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22694 default_backend back-static
22695
22696 backend back-static
22697 mode http
22698 server www A.B.C.D:80
22699
22700 backend back-dynamic
22701 mode http
22702 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22703 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22704
22705 fcgi-app php-fpm
22706 log-stderr global
22707 option keep-conn
22708
22709 docroot /var/www/my-app
22710 index index.php
22711 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22712
22713
2271410.2. Default parameters
22715------------------------
22716
22717A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22718the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022719script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022720applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22721
22722 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22723 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22724 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22725 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22726 | | |
22727 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22728 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22729 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22730 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22731 | | application. |
22732 | | |
22733 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22734 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22735 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22736 | | |
22737 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22738 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22739 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22740 | | the application's configuration. |
22741 | | |
22742 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22743 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22744 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22745 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22746 | | |
22747 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22748 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22749 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22750 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22751 | | be defined. |
22752 | | |
22753 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22754 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22755 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22756 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22757 | | is not set too. |
22758 | | |
22759 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22760 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22761 | | set. |
22762 | | |
22763 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22764 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22765 | | the request. |
22766 | | |
22767 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22768 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22769 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22770 | | |
22771 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22772 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22773 | | script to process the request. |
22774 | | |
22775 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22776 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22777 | | |
22778 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22779 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22780 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22781 | | |
22782 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22783 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22784 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22785 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22786 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22787 | | |
22788 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22789 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22790 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22791 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22792 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22793 | | side. |
22794 | | |
22795 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22796 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22797 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22798 | | connected to. |
22799 | | |
22800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22801 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22802 | | |
22803 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022804 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22805 | | current HAProxy version. |
22806 | | |
22807 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022808 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22809 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22810 | | |
22811 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22812
22813
2281410.3. Limitations
22815------------------
22816
22817The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22818way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22819during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22820establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22821application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22822or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22823message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22824these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22825and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22826
22827Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22828request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22829requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22830
22831About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22832into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22833fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22834"http-request" ones.
22835
22836Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22837FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22838processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22839must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22840here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022841
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022842
2284311. Address formats
22844-------------------
22845
22846Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22847address.
22848
22849This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22850The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22851of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22852equivalent is '::'.
22853
22854Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22855is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22856
22857This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22858family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22859
22860Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22861configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22862use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22863'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22864
22865Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22866socket type and the transport method.
22867
22868
2286911.1 Address family prefixes
22870----------------------------
22871
22872'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22873
22874'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22875 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22876 listening.
22877
22878'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22879 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22880 on the statement using this address, a port or
22881 a port range may or must be specified.
22882
22883'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22884 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22885 using this address, a port or a port range
22886 may or must be specified.
22887
22888'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22889 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22890 using this address, a port or a port range
22891 may or must be specified.
22892
22893'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22894 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22895 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22896 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22897 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22898 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22899
22900'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22901 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22902 start by slash '/'.
22903
22904
2290511.2 Socket type prefixes
22906-------------------------
22907
22908Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22909type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22910this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22911This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22912but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22913
22914Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22915instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22916
22917If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22918they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22919report this to the maintainers.
22920
22921'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22922 to "stream"
22923
22924'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22925 to "datagram".
22926
22927
2292811.3 Protocol prefixes
22929----------------------
22930
22931'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22932 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22933 socket type and transport method is forced to
22934 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22935 this address, a port or a port range can or
22936 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22937 of 'stream+ip@'.
22938
22939'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22940 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22941 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22942 statement using this address, a port or port
22943 range can or must be specified.
22944 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22945
22946'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22947 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22948 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22949 statement using this address, a port or port
22950 range can or must be specified.
22951 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22952
22953'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22954 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22955 socket type and transport method is forced to
22956 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22957 this address, a port or a port range can or
22958 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22959 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22960
22961'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22962 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22963 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22964 the statement using this address, a port or
22965 port range can or must be specified.
22966 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22967
22968'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22969 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22970 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22971 the statement using this address, a port or
22972 port range can or must be specified.
22973 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22974
22975'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22976 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22977 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22978
22979'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22980 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22981 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22982
22983In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22984QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022986/*
22987 * Local variables:
22988 * fill-column: 79
22989 * End:
22990 */